WO2016017828A1 - トナーカートリッジ、トナー供給機構、シャッタ - Google Patents
トナーカートリッジ、トナー供給機構、シャッタ Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- WO2016017828A1 WO2016017828A1 PCT/JP2015/072438 JP2015072438W WO2016017828A1 WO 2016017828 A1 WO2016017828 A1 WO 2016017828A1 JP 2015072438 W JP2015072438 W JP 2015072438W WO 2016017828 A1 WO2016017828 A1 WO 2016017828A1
- Authority
- WO
- WIPO (PCT)
- Prior art keywords
- toner cartridge
- opening
- cartridge according
- closing member
- closing
- Prior art date
Links
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 title claims description 10
- 238000007599 discharging Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 22
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 claims description 210
- 230000037431 insertion Effects 0.000 claims description 210
- 230000001105 regulatory effect Effects 0.000 claims description 118
- 238000003860 storage Methods 0.000 claims description 75
- 238000011144 upstream manufacturing Methods 0.000 claims description 32
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 claims description 19
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 claims description 7
- 230000033228 biological regulation Effects 0.000 claims description 4
- 239000011435 rock Substances 0.000 claims 3
- 230000004308 accommodation Effects 0.000 abstract 2
- 210000000078 claw Anatomy 0.000 description 208
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 description 76
- 238000010586 diagram Methods 0.000 description 54
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 description 40
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 description 28
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 27
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 27
- 238000007789 sealing Methods 0.000 description 11
- 238000003756 stirring Methods 0.000 description 10
- 230000005484 gravity Effects 0.000 description 9
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 8
- 238000004140 cleaning Methods 0.000 description 7
- 238000011084 recovery Methods 0.000 description 7
- 238000011161 development Methods 0.000 description 6
- 238000006073 displacement reaction Methods 0.000 description 6
- 238000000605 extraction Methods 0.000 description 6
- 239000011347 resin Substances 0.000 description 5
- 229920005989 resin Polymers 0.000 description 5
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000009434 installation Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000003825 pressing Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000005520 cutting process Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000007423 decrease Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000005489 elastic deformation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000003287 optical effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 108091008695 photoreceptors Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 230000002776 aggregation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000004220 aggregation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000013019 agitation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000903 blocking effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010276 construction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002542 deteriorative effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000004744 fabric Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000006872 improvement Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001678 irradiating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012423 maintenance Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000465 moulding Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001629 suppression Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002699 waste material Substances 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G21/00—Arrangements not provided for by groups G03G13/00 - G03G19/00, e.g. cleaning, elimination of residual charge
- G03G21/16—Mechanical means for facilitating the maintenance of the apparatus, e.g. modular arrangements
- G03G21/1642—Mechanical means for facilitating the maintenance of the apparatus, e.g. modular arrangements for connecting the different parts of the apparatus
- G03G21/1647—Mechanical connection means
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G15/00—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern
- G03G15/06—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing
- G03G15/08—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing using a solid developer, e.g. powder developer
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G15/00—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern
- G03G15/06—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing
- G03G15/08—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing using a solid developer, e.g. powder developer
- G03G15/0822—Arrangements for preparing, mixing, supplying or dispensing developer
- G03G15/0865—Arrangements for supplying new developer
- G03G15/0867—Arrangements for supplying new developer cylindrical developer cartridges, e.g. toner bottles for the developer replenishing opening
- G03G15/0868—Toner cartridges fulfilling a continuous function within the electrographic apparatus during the use of the supplied developer material, e.g. toner discharge on demand, storing residual toner, acting as an active closure for the developer replenishing opening
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G15/00—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern
- G03G15/06—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing
- G03G15/08—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing using a solid developer, e.g. powder developer
- G03G15/0822—Arrangements for preparing, mixing, supplying or dispensing developer
- G03G15/0865—Arrangements for supplying new developer
- G03G15/0867—Arrangements for supplying new developer cylindrical developer cartridges, e.g. toner bottles for the developer replenishing opening
- G03G15/087—Developer cartridges having a longitudinal rotational axis, around which at least one part is rotated when mounting or using the cartridge
- G03G15/0872—Developer cartridges having a longitudinal rotational axis, around which at least one part is rotated when mounting or using the cartridge the developer cartridges being generally horizontally mounted parallel to its longitudinal rotational axis
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G15/00—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern
- G03G15/06—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing
- G03G15/08—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing using a solid developer, e.g. powder developer
- G03G15/0822—Arrangements for preparing, mixing, supplying or dispensing developer
- G03G15/0877—Arrangements for metering and dispensing developer from a developer cartridge into the development unit
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G15/00—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern
- G03G15/06—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing
- G03G15/08—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing using a solid developer, e.g. powder developer
- G03G15/0822—Arrangements for preparing, mixing, supplying or dispensing developer
- G03G15/0877—Arrangements for metering and dispensing developer from a developer cartridge into the development unit
- G03G15/0881—Sealing of developer cartridges
- G03G15/0886—Sealing of developer cartridges by mechanical means, e.g. shutter, plug
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G15/00—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern
- G03G15/06—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing
- G03G15/08—Apparatus for electrographic processes using a charge pattern for developing using a solid developer, e.g. powder developer
- G03G15/0822—Arrangements for preparing, mixing, supplying or dispensing developer
- G03G15/0887—Arrangements for conveying and conditioning developer in the developing unit, e.g. agitating, removing impurities or humidity
- G03G15/0891—Arrangements for conveying and conditioning developer in the developing unit, e.g. agitating, removing impurities or humidity for conveying or circulating developer, e.g. augers
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G21/00—Arrangements not provided for by groups G03G13/00 - G03G19/00, e.g. cleaning, elimination of residual charge
- G03G21/16—Mechanical means for facilitating the maintenance of the apparatus, e.g. modular arrangements
- G03G21/1661—Mechanical means for facilitating the maintenance of the apparatus, e.g. modular arrangements means for handling parts of the apparatus in the apparatus
- G03G21/1676—Mechanical means for facilitating the maintenance of the apparatus, e.g. modular arrangements means for handling parts of the apparatus in the apparatus for the developer unit
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G21/00—Arrangements not provided for by groups G03G13/00 - G03G19/00, e.g. cleaning, elimination of residual charge
- G03G21/16—Mechanical means for facilitating the maintenance of the apparatus, e.g. modular arrangements
- G03G21/18—Mechanical means for facilitating the maintenance of the apparatus, e.g. modular arrangements using a processing cartridge, whereby the process cartridge comprises at least two image processing means in a single unit
- G03G21/1803—Arrangements or disposition of the complete process cartridge or parts thereof
- G03G21/1828—Prevention of damage or soiling, e.g. mechanical abrasion
- G03G21/1832—Shielding members, shutter, e.g. light, heat shielding, prevention of toner scattering
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G2215/00—Apparatus for electrophotographic processes
- G03G2215/06—Developing structures, details
- G03G2215/066—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material
- G03G2215/0663—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material having a longitudinal rotational axis, around which at least one part is rotated when mounting or using the cartridge
- G03G2215/0665—Generally horizontally mounting of said toner cartridge parallel to its longitudinal rotational axis
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G2215/00—Apparatus for electrophotographic processes
- G03G2215/06—Developing structures, details
- G03G2215/066—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material
- G03G2215/0663—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material having a longitudinal rotational axis, around which at least one part is rotated when mounting or using the cartridge
- G03G2215/0665—Generally horizontally mounting of said toner cartridge parallel to its longitudinal rotational axis
- G03G2215/067—Toner discharging opening covered by arcuate shutter
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G2215/00—Apparatus for electrophotographic processes
- G03G2215/06—Developing structures, details
- G03G2215/066—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material
- G03G2215/0663—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material having a longitudinal rotational axis, around which at least one part is rotated when mounting or using the cartridge
- G03G2215/0675—Generally cylindrical container shape having two ends
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G2215/00—Apparatus for electrophotographic processes
- G03G2215/06—Developing structures, details
- G03G2215/066—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material
- G03G2215/0685—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material fulfilling a continuous function within the electrographic apparatus during the use of the supplied developer material, e.g. toner discharge on demand, storing residual toner, not acting as a passive closure for the developer replenishing opening
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G2215/00—Apparatus for electrophotographic processes
- G03G2215/06—Developing structures, details
- G03G2215/066—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material
- G03G2215/0692—Toner cartridge or other attachable and detachable container for supplying developer material to replace the used material using a slidable sealing member, e.g. shutter
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G03—PHOTOGRAPHY; CINEMATOGRAPHY; ANALOGOUS TECHNIQUES USING WAVES OTHER THAN OPTICAL WAVES; ELECTROGRAPHY; HOLOGRAPHY
- G03G—ELECTROGRAPHY; ELECTROPHOTOGRAPHY; MAGNETOGRAPHY
- G03G2215/00—Apparatus for electrophotographic processes
- G03G2215/08—Details of powder developing device not concerning the development directly
- G03G2215/0802—Arrangements for agitating or circulating developer material
- G03G2215/085—Stirring member in developer container
Definitions
- an electrophotographic image forming apparatus a configuration in which elements such as a photosensitive drum and a developing roller as a rotating body related to image formation are integrated as a cartridge and is detachable from an image forming apparatus main body (hereinafter referred to as an apparatus main body) is known. Yes.
- the toner cartridge containing the toner (developer) consumed during the image formation can be replaced separately from the photosensitive drum and the developing roller.
- the configuration is also known.
- the toner (developer) accommodated in the toner cartridge is transferred from the discharge port to a developing device having a developing roller or the like.
- a configuration is known in which an opening / closing member such as a shutter for opening and closing the discharge port is provided in order to prevent toner from leaking from the discharge port to the outside.
- Japanese Patent Laid-Open No. 7-199623 discloses a configuration in which a shutter is opened by rotating a toner cartridge when a cylindrical toner cartridge (developer supply container) is mounted on the main body of the image forming apparatus. Yes.
- the object of the present invention is to develop the above-described conventional technology.
- the first invention is: A toner cartridge detachable from the receiving device, A container having a storage portion for storing toner, and a discharge port for discharging toner from the storage portion to the receiving device; An opening / closing member having a closing portion for closing the discharge port, and an engaging portion movable with respect to the closing portion, and (a) an open position for opening the discharge port to the closing portion; (B) a closing position for closing the discharge port at the closing portion, and an opening / closing member capable of rotating with respect to the container.
- a toner cartridge detachable from the receiving device A container having a storage portion for storing toner, and a discharge port for discharging toner from the storage portion to the receiving device; An opening / closing member having a closing portion for closing the discharge port, and an engaging portion movable with respect to the closing portion, and (a) an open position for opening the discharge port to the closing portion; (B) a closing position for closing the discharge port at the closing portion, and an opening / closing member capable of rotating with respect to the container.
- the third invention is A toner cartridge that can be mounted on a receiving device by a mounting operation involving a rotation operation,
- a container having a container for containing toner, and an opening for discharging the toner from the container to the receiving device;
- An opening / closing member having a closing part for closing the opening part, and an engaging part movable with respect to the closing part, and (a) an open position for opening the opening part to the closing part;
- the engaging portion is (c) a member for engaging the receiving device to receive a force for moving the opening / closing member from the open position to the closed position when the toner cartridge is removed from the receiving device. Movable between the closed position and (d) the retracted position retracted from the engagement position with respect to the closing portion;
- the engaging portion is configured to move from the retracted position to the engaging position in accordance with the rotating operation.
- the fourth invention is: A toner cartridge removable from the receiving device by a removal operation involving a rotation operation, A container having a container for containing toner, and an opening for discharging the toner from the container to the receiving device; An opening / closing member having a closing part for closing the opening part, and an engaging part movable with respect to the closing part, and (a) an open position for opening the opening part to the closing part; (B) an open / close member that can move relative to the container between a closed position in which the opening closes the opening; Have The engaging portion is (c) a member for engaging the receiving device to receive a force for moving the opening / closing member from the open position to the closed position when the toner cartridge is removed from the receiving device. Movable between the closed position and (d) the retracted position retracted from the engagement position with respect to the closing portion; The engaging portion is configured to move from the engaging position to the retracted position in accordance with the rotating operation.
- the fifth invention is: A toner cartridge detachable from the receiving device, A container having a storage portion for storing toner, and a discharge port for discharging toner from the storage portion to the receiving device; A closing portion for closing the discharge port; and an engaging portion movable with respect to the closing portion; (a) an open position for opening the discharge port to the closing portion; An opening / closing member that can move relative to the container between a closing position that causes the closing portion to close the discharge port, and the engaging portion is (c) moving the opening / closing member from the open position to the closed position. Between an engagement position for engaging the receiving device to receive a force for moving the toner cartridge when it is removed from the receiving device, and (d) a retracted position retracted from the engaging position.
- An opening / closing member movable relative to the closing portion;
- a retracted position moving part provided in the container for moving the engaging part from the engaged position to the retracted position as the opening / closing member moves from the open position to the closed position; It is characterized by having.
- the sixth invention is: In a toner cartridge for forming an electrophotographic image, A container having a storage portion for storing toner and a discharge port for discharging the toner from the storage portion; A closing portion for closing the discharge port; and an engaging portion movable with respect to the closing portion; an open position for causing the closing portion to open the discharge port; and An open / close member that can rotate relative to the container between a closed position for closing the discharge port, and As the opening / closing member rotates between the closed position and the open position, the engagement portion is configured to move at least in the rotation axis direction of the opening / closing member with respect to the closing portion.
- the seventh invention In a toner cartridge for forming an electrophotographic image, A container having a storage portion for storing toner and a discharge port for discharging the toner from the storage portion; A closing portion for closing the discharge port; and an engaging portion movable with respect to the closing portion; an open position for causing the closing portion to open the discharge port; and An open / close member that can rotate relative to the container between a closed position for closing the discharge port, and The engagement portion is exposed at least on the outer side in the rotational radius direction of the opening and closing member, As the opening / closing member rotates between the closed position and the open position, the engaging portion is configured to move at least in the rotational radius direction of the opening / closing member with respect to the closing portion.
- the eighth invention In a toner cartridge for forming an electrophotographic image, A container having a storage portion for storing toner and a discharge port for discharging the toner from the storage portion; A closing portion for closing the discharge port; and an engaging portion movable with respect to the closing portion; an open position for causing the closing portion to open the discharge port; and An open / close member that can rotate relative to the container between a closed position for closing the discharge port, and
- the engaging portion is A first protrusion protruding at least outward of the opening / closing member in the radial direction of rotation; A second protrusion provided on the first protrusion, wherein the opening / closing member protrudes toward the downstream side in the direction of rotation from the closed position to the open position with respect to the container;
- the ninth invention In a toner cartridge for forming an electrophotographic image, A container having a storage portion for storing toner and a discharge port for discharging the toner from the storage portion; A closing portion for closing the discharge port; and an engaging portion movable with respect to the closing portion; an open position for causing the closing portion to open the discharge port; and An open / close member that can move relative to the container between a closed position for closing the discharge port, and A moving part provided in the container for moving the engaging part as the opening / closing member moves from the open position to the closed position; It is characterized by having.
- the tenth invention is In a shutter used for a toner cartridge, A body portion that is substantially arc-shaped; A first arm portion provided at an end portion in the longitudinal direction of the main body portion, the first arm portion extending toward an end portion side in the short direction of the main body portion; A first protrusion provided on a distal end side of the first arm portion and protruding outward in a radial direction of the arc shape; Have The first protrusion is movable with respect to the main body at least in the longitudinal direction of the main body.
- FIG. 1 is a side view of the toner cartridge according to the embodiment.
- FIG. 2 is a cross-sectional view schematically showing a schematic configuration of the image forming apparatus according to the embodiment.
- FIG. 3 is a side cross-sectional view schematically showing a state where the toner cartridge is mounted on the developing unit.
- FIG. 4 is a perspective view schematically showing the developing unit according to the embodiment.
- FIG. 5 is a schematic diagram of the toner cartridge according to the embodiment.
- FIG. 6 is a schematic diagram of the developing unit and the toner cartridge before installation (insertion).
- FIG. 7 is a schematic diagram of the developing unit and the toner cartridge in the middle of installation (insertion).
- FIG. 8 is a side view schematically showing a modified example of the configuration of the insertion guide portion.
- FIG. 9 is a side view schematically showing a force relationship acting on the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 10 is a schematic diagram showing a state in which the butted portion and the butted portion are in contact with each other.
- FIG. 11 is a schematic diagram when the toner cartridge is positioned by rotating the container frame.
- FIG. 12 is a schematic diagram when the respective shutters are moved to the open position and the respective toner storage portions are communicated.
- FIG. 13 is a schematic diagram illustrating the configuration of the image forming apparatus according to the embodiment.
- FIG. 14 is a partial sectional side view of the vicinity of the opening of the developing unit and the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 15 is a sectional view showing a schematic configuration of the developing unit and the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 16 is an exploded perspective view of the vicinity of the opening of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 17 is a perspective view showing the shutter opening / closing operation of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 18 is an exploded perspective view of the vicinity of the opening of the developing unit.
- FIG. 19 is an exploded perspective view showing the shutter opening / closing operation of the developing unit.
- FIG. 20 is a schematic sectional side view of the toner cartridge and the developing unit.
- FIG. 21 is a perspective view of the toner cartridge and the developing unit.
- FIG. 22 is a schematic cross-sectional view of the developing unit and the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 23 is a schematic side cross-sectional view around the shutter portion.
- FIG. 24A is a cross-sectional view taken along A1 in FIG. 16
- FIG. 24B is a cross-sectional view taken along A2 in FIG. 18,
- FIG. 24C is a cross-sectional view taken along A3 in FIG.
- FIG. 25 is a side sectional view of the developing unit and the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram when the communication portion is viewed from the first toner accommodating portion side.
- FIG. 27 is a schematic cross-sectional view of the developing unit and the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 28 is a view for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter of the developing unit and the second shutter of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 29 is a diagram for explaining a detailed configuration near the receiving portion of the toner cartridge of the developing unit.
- FIG. 30 is a diagram for explaining a detailed configuration near the receiving portion of the toner cartridge of the developing unit.
- FIG. 31 is a diagram for explaining a detailed configuration near the receiving portion of the toner cartridge of the developing unit.
- FIG. 32 is a diagram for explaining the detailed configuration of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 33 is a diagram for explaining the detailed configuration of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 34 is a diagram for explaining the detailed configuration of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 35 is a diagram for explaining the detailed configuration of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 36 is a diagram for explaining the detailed configuration of the toner cartridge.
- FIG. 37 is a view for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 38 is a diagram for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 39 is a diagram for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 40 is a diagram for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 41 is a diagram for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 42 is a diagram for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 43 is a diagram for explaining the opening operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 44 is a cross-sectional view of the vicinity of the second opening and the third opening as seen from the driving side.
- FIG. 45 is a diagram for explaining a toner conveyance configuration from the toner cartridge to the developing unit.
- FIG. 46 is a diagram for explaining the closing operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 47 is a diagram for explaining the closing operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 48 is a diagram for explaining the closing operation of the first shutter and the second shutter.
- FIG. 49 is a perspective view for explaining a state before the toner cartridge is mounted on the developing unit.
- FIG. 50 is a longitudinal sectional view showing the inserted guide portion (drive) and the vicinity of the insertion guide portion (drive).
- FIG. 51 is a cross-sectional view showing the shapes of the inserted guide portion (drive) and the insertion guide portion (drive).
- FIG. 52 is a cross-sectional view showing the shapes of the inserted guide portion (drive) and the insertion guide portion (drive).
- 53 is a longitudinal sectional view showing the vicinity of the insertion guide portion (non-) and the insertion guide portion (non-).
- FIG. 54 is a view showing the relationship between the inserted guide portion (drive) and the inserted guide portion (non-).
- FIG. 55 is a view for explaining the relationship between the inserted guide portion (drive) and the inserted guide portion (non-).
- FIG. 56 is an explanatory view showing a state in which the second shutter is in the closed position.
- FIG. 57 is an explanatory view showing a state where the second shutter is in the open position.
- FIG. 58 is an explanatory diagram showing the second shutter.
- FIG. 59 is an explanatory diagram showing the second shutter.
- FIG. 60 is an explanatory view showing a state in which the second shutter is in the closed position.
- FIG. 61 is an explanatory diagram showing a state where the second shutter is in the closed position.
- FIG. 62 is an explanatory diagram showing a state where the second shutter is in the open position.
- FIG. 63 is an explanatory diagram showing a state in which the second shutter is in the closed position.
- FIG. 64 is an explanatory diagram of the toner cartridge.
- the image forming apparatus forms an image on a recording medium using, for example, an electrophotographic image forming process.
- an electrophotographic copying machine for example, an LED printer, a laser beam printer, etc.
- an electrophotographic facsimile machine and the like are included.
- a monochrome image forming apparatus provided with one toner image forming unit is illustrated.
- the number of toner image forming units provided in the image forming apparatus is not limited to this.
- the image forming apparatus may have a plurality of toner image forming units and form a color image.
- the upper direction means the upper direction in the gravity direction when the image forming apparatus is installed.
- the present invention relates to an improvement in operation feeling when a user mounts a toner cartridge on a developing unit (developing cartridge).
- FIG. 2 is a side sectional configuration diagram showing the configuration of the image forming apparatus A according to the present embodiment.
- the image forming apparatus A shown in FIG. 2 receives image information from an external device such as a personal computer connected so as to be communicable. Then, according to the received image information, the image forming apparatus A forms an image (toner image) with a developer (toner) on a recording medium P (for example, recording paper, an OHP sheet, cloth, etc.) by an electrophotographic image forming process. To do.
- an external device such as a personal computer connected so as to be communicable.
- the image forming apparatus A forms an image (toner image) with a developer (toner) on a recording medium P (for example, recording paper, an OHP sheet, cloth, etc.) by an electrophotographic image forming process.
- a recording medium P for example, recording paper, an OHP sheet, cloth, etc.
- the image forming apparatus A is configured such that a toner image forming unit (toner image forming unit) B is detachable from the apparatus main body.
- the toner image forming unit (toner image forming unit) B of this embodiment includes a drum unit (drum cartridge) C, a developing unit (developing device, developing cartridge) D, and a toner cartridge E.
- the toner cartridge E is detachable from the developing unit D. That is, the developing unit D has a mounting portion for mounting the toner cartridge E, and is a receiving device (receiving device) that receives the toner cartridge E.
- the toner image forming unit (toner image forming unit) can be regarded as a unit including a photosensitive drum and an element acting on the photosensitive drum.
- the drum unit C, the developing unit D, and the toner cartridge E of the present embodiment are cartridges that are each configured to be detachable from the apparatus main body.
- the drum unit C may be referred to as a drum cartridge
- the developing unit D may be referred to as a developing cartridge.
- drum unit C, the developing unit D, and the toner cartridge E do not have to be individually formed into cartridges.
- the photosensitive drum or the drum unit having the photosensitive drum
- the photosensitive drum may be fixed to the apparatus main body, and only the developing unit (developing cartridge) D and the toner cartridge E may be detachable.
- drum unit C and the developing unit D may be integrated and detachable from the apparatus main body as a single cartridge.
- a cartridge in which the drum unit C and the developing unit D are integrated may be particularly referred to as a process cartridge.
- the toner cartridge E is attached to and detached from the process cartridge.
- the process cartridge can be regarded as a receiving device.
- An image forming apparatus employing the process cartridge configuration will be described later in a fourth embodiment.
- the photosensitive drum and the developing unit may be fixed to the apparatus main body, and only the toner cartridge E may be detachable from the apparatus main body.
- the image forming apparatus main body itself can be regarded as a receiving device for the toner cartridge E.
- the combined portion of the receiving device (developing unit D) and the toner cartridge E may be called a toner supply mechanism (toner supply unit, toner supply device) or the like.
- toner supply mechanism toner supply unit, toner supply device
- toner is supplied (supplied) from the toner cartridge E to the receiving device.
- the photosensitive drum as the image carrier indicates a configuration in which a flange or the like is integrated with a cylinder having a photosensitive layer.
- the apparatus main body image forming apparatus main body refers to a component obtained by removing each cartridge (drum unit C, developing unit D, toner cartridge E) from the image forming apparatus A.
- the drum unit C is a unit in which a photosensitive drum (image carrier) 16, a charging roller 17, a cleaning blade 19, and the like are integrally formed.
- the drum unit C is a cartridge (drum cartridge) that can be attached to and detached from the apparatus main body.
- the developing unit D is a unit in which a developing roller (developer carrying member) 24 and the like are integrally formed.
- the developing unit D is a cartridge (developing cartridge) that can be attached to and detached from the apparatus main body.
- the toner cartridge E as a developer container is a cartridge in which a toner storage container (developer storage container, container) 47 for storing toner t as a developer is integrally formed as a cartridge.
- the photosensitive drum 16 rotates in the direction of arrow a shown in FIG.
- the surface of the rotating photosensitive drum 16 is uniformly charged by a charging roller 17 as charging means.
- a charging roller 17 As charging means.
- the photosensitive drum 16 By irradiating the photosensitive drum 16 with laser light L corresponding to the image information from the laser scanner (exposure means) 1, an electrostatic latent image corresponding to the image information is formed on the photosensitive drum 16.
- the toner t carried and conveyed by the developing roller 24 develops the electrostatic latent image. As a result, a toner image is formed on the photosensitive drum 16.
- the frame 35 of the developing unit D as a receiving device supports the developing roller 24 in a rotatable manner.
- the developing roller 24 is rotationally driven with respect to the photosensitive drum 16 in the forward direction (the direction of arrow b in the figure).
- the toner t in the developing chamber 31 is carried on the peripheral surface of the developing roller 24 with the layer thickness regulated by the developing blade 25.
- the layer thickness is regulated, a charge is imparted to the toner by frictional charging.
- the charged toner forms an electrostatic latent image on the photosensitive drum 16.
- the developing chamber 31 communicates with the first toner accommodating portion (developer accommodating portion) 28 through the first opening 29.
- a first toner conveying means 27 that is rotationally driven by a drive source (not shown) supplies toner t from the first toner storage portion 28 to the developing chamber 31.
- a communication portion 58 is formed by the second opening (container opening / receiving port, receiving opening) 30 and the third opening (container opening / discharge port, discharge opening) 49.
- the first toner accommodating portion (container accommodating chamber) 28 communicates with the second toner accommodating portion (container accommodating chamber) 47 t of the toner cartridge E via the communication portion 58.
- the second toner storage portion 47t is a space provided inside the container 47 for storing toner.
- the second toner container 47t is a container (toner container, developer container) formed by the frame (container frame 47a) of the container 47.
- the third opening 49 is formed in the container frame 47a and is a discharge port for discharging the toner from the second toner container 47t toward the outside of the toner container 47 (that is, the developing unit D).
- the toner discharged from the third opening 49 is received in the second opening 30 of the developing unit D.
- the first toner storage unit 28 is supplied with the toner t from the second toner storage unit 47t by the second toner transport member 46 rotated by the driving force input from the apparatus main body via the developing unit D.
- the recording medium P set in the feeding cassette 2 is separated and fed one by one by a pickup roller 3 and a pressure contact member 5 that is in pressure contact therewith. Then, in synchronization with the toner image formed on the photosensitive drum, the recording medium P is conveyed along the conveyance guide 4 to a transfer roller 6 as a transfer unit.
- the recording medium P passes through the transfer nip portion 11 formed by the photosensitive drum 16 and the transfer roller 6 to which a constant voltage is applied. At this time, the toner image formed on the photosensitive drum 16 is transferred to the recording medium P.
- the recording medium P to which the toner image is transferred is conveyed to the fixing unit 8 by the conveyance guide 7.
- the fixing means 8 includes a driving roller 8a and a fixing roller 8c incorporating a heater 8b.
- the recording medium P receives heat and pressure passing through the nip portion 8d formed by the fixing roller 8c and the driving roller 8a. As a result, the toner image transferred onto the recording medium P is fixed to the recording medium P. Thereafter, the recording medium P on which the toner image is fixed is conveyed by the discharge roller pair 9 and discharged to the discharge tray 10.
- the cleaning blade 19 is provided so as to elastically contact the outer peripheral surface of the photosensitive drum 16. As a result, the toner t (transfer residual toner) remaining on the photosensitive drum 16 that has not been transferred to the recording medium P is scraped off by the cleaning blade 19. The toner t thus scraped off is stored in a removed toner storage portion (waste toner storage portion) 18a of the frame 18 to which the cleaning blade 19 is fixed.
- an image forming apparatus of the present embodiment has been described with respect to the configuration in which an image is formed on a recording medium (recording material) using a developer (toner) by an electrophotographic image forming method.
- an image forming apparatus may form an image on a recording medium, and an electrophotographic copying machine, an electrophotographic printer (laser beam printer, LED printer, etc.), an electrophotographic facsimile apparatus, an electrophotographic word processor, etc. There is no.
- the toner image forming portion B has an electrophotographic photosensitive member (photosensitive member) that is an image carrier and process means that acts on the photosensitive member.
- the toner image forming unit is configured to be detachable from the apparatus main body of the image forming apparatus as one or more cartridges.
- Process means include charging means (charging member, charging device), developing means (developing device, developing unit), cleaning means (cleaning device, cleaning member), and the like.
- the developing device is a device used for developing an electrostatic latent image on a photoreceptor.
- the developing device (developing unit) is made into a cartridge and can be detachably attached to the image forming apparatus.
- a developing device may constitute a part of the process cartridge.
- the toner cartridge (developer cartridge, toner bottle, developer bottle, toner container, developer container) stores developer (toner) used to develop the electrostatic latent image formed on the photoreceptor.
- Cartridge ⁇ 2. [Configuration of each cartridge (unit)]
- each cartridge (each unit) detachably provided in the image forming apparatus. (Detailed description near the toner cartridge receiving part of the developing unit)
- FIG. 4 is a perspective view of the vicinity of the receiving portion (mounting portion) of the toner cartridge E of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 4A is a view for explaining a state where the second opening 30 is closed (the first shutter 37 is in the closed position).
- FIG. 4B is a diagram for explaining a state in which the second opening 30 is opened (the first shutter 37 is in the open position).
- the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D indicates a direction parallel to the rotational axis direction of the developing roller 24 provided in the developing unit D. In the state where the toner cartridge E is mounted on the developing unit, the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E is substantially parallel to the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D.
- the developing unit D is configured such that the toner cartridge E can be attached to the receiving portion (removable) in the frame (developing frame) 35.
- the developing unit D has a second opening (a container opening, a receiving port) 30 and a first shutter (a container shutter, a receiving device side shutter, a receiving device side opening / closing member) 37.
- the second opening 30 is provided at the center in the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D.
- the position of the second opening 30 is not limited to the central portion in the longitudinal direction as long as it is a position facing a third opening (container opening) 49 described later.
- the second opening 30 is sealed by a first shutter 37 having a curvature along the outer peripheral surface of the toner cartridge E.
- the first shutter 37 has a hole 37a that engages with a convex portion (container side engaging portion, opening / closing member moving portion, container side protrusion) 45 provided on a toner cartridge E as a developer container.
- the hole 37 is provided outside the sealing range where the first shutter 37 seals the second opening 30.
- both longitudinal end portions of the first shutter 37 are engaged with first shutter guide portions 34 provided on both sides in the longitudinal direction of the second opening 30 in the frame 35 of the developing unit D.
- the first shutter is configured to be slidable (movable) along the first shutter guide portion 34.
- the first shutter 37 closes the second opening 30 (reception port closed position, FIG. 4A), and opens the second opening 30 (reception port open position, FIG. 4B). )).
- a first sealing seal 32 for sealing between the first shutter 37 and the second opening 30 is attached to the frame 35 of the developing unit D so as to surround the second opening 30. It has been.
- the development unit D includes insertion guide portions 35d and 36d that guide the toner cartridge E while maintaining the posture (mounting posture) of the toner cartridge E when the toner cartridge E is loaded (inserted) at both ends in the longitudinal direction of the frame 35.
- the developing unit D has abutted portions 35a and 36a against which the abutting portions 42a and 43a of the toner cartridge E abut when inserted as will be described later.
- the developing unit D includes rotation guide portions 35b and 36b that guide the rotation of the toner cartridge E when opening and closing the first shutter 37 and the second shutter (container shutter) 53 at both ends in the longitudinal direction of the frame 35. Have.
- the insertion guide portions 35d and 36d are formed linearly and parallel to each other along the insertion direction f (FIG. 4A) of the toner cartridge E. If the insertion direction of the toner cartridge E is considered as the mounting direction, the downstream side in the mounting direction can be regarded as the mounting direction, and the upstream side in the mounting direction can be regarded as the removal direction.
- the abutted portion 35a and the rotation guide portion 35b are on the downstream side in the insertion direction f of the insertion guide portion 35d on the non-driving side, and the abutted portion 36a and the rotation guide 36b are on the insertion guide portion 36d on the driving side.
- Each is provided downstream in the insertion direction f.
- the side where the drive unit (eg, first drive transmission unit 38) such as a gear is disposed on both ends in the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D is hereinafter referred to as a drive side.
- the non-driving side of the developing unit is used to mean the side opposite to the driving side.
- a first drive transmission portion 38 for transmitting driving to a second toner conveying means 46 of a toner cartridge E described later is provided at one end portion in the longitudinal direction of the frame body 35.
- the first drive transmission unit 38 is a gear, and is connected to the drive mechanism of the image forming apparatus main body inside the developing unit D.
- the first drive transmission portion 38 is a rotational force receiving portion (driving force receiving portion) that receives a rotational force for driving the second toner conveying member 46 from the outside of the toner cartridge E.
- the developing unit D is provided with holes 33 on both outer sides in the longitudinal direction of the second opening 30 in the frame 35.
- the hole portion 33 engages with a claw portion 53b provided on the second shutter 53 of the toner cartridge E described later.
- the claw part 53b is an engaging part (opening / closing member side engaging part) provided at the tip of the arm part 53a. Accordingly, when the third opening 49 is opened and closed, the second shutter 53 is prevented from being rotated with a container frame 47a described later. (Detailed description of toner cartridge)
- FIG. 5A is a perspective view of the toner cartridge E as viewed from the second drive transmission unit 48 side (drive side).
- FIG. 5B is a perspective view of the toner cartridge E viewed from the side opposite to the second drive transmission unit 48 side (non-drive side).
- FIG. 5C is a cross-sectional view of the toner cartridge E when viewed from the side opposite to the second drive transmission portion 48 side.
- FIG. 5D is a perspective view when the second shutter 53 of the toner cartridge E is in the open position (a state where the third opening 49 is opened).
- the toner cartridge E is attached to the container 47, a second shutter 53 that can move relative to the container 47 (developer container shutter) 53, a second toner conveying member 46 provided inside the container 47, and the second toner conveying member 46.
- the second drive transmission unit (gear) 48 and the like are provided.
- the container 47 has a substantially cylindrical shape. That is, the frame (container frame) 47a constituting the main body portion (main portion) of the container 47 has a substantially cylindrical shape.
- the container 47 has a gripping member 44.
- the holding member 44 is a U-shaped protrusion formed integrally with the frame body 47a.
- the shape of the gripping member 44 is not limited to the U-shape, and the gripping member 44 may be configured by a member different from the frame body 47a and attached to the frame body 47a.
- the container frame (cylindrical portion) 47a is hollow and forms a second toner containing portion 47t in which toner is contained. Further, the container frame 47a has a third opening 49 for discharging the toner in the second toner storage portion 47t on the peripheral surface thereof.
- a second sealing seal 54 that seals between the container frame 47 a and the second shutter 53 is attached to the container frame 47 a so as to surround the third opening 49.
- the container frame 47a includes two convex portions 45 provided on the outer periphery of the cylindrical shape so as to be engageable with the hole 37a of the first shutter 37.
- the two protrusions 45 are protrusions protruding in substantially the same direction.
- a line connecting the two convex portions 45 is substantially parallel to the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E.
- the two convex portions 45 are disposed outside the third opening 49. More specifically, when the two protrusions 45 and the third opening 49 are projected on a virtual line parallel to the rotation axis of the second shutter 53, the third opening is within the range of the region between the two protrusions. The entire part 49 is located.
- a second toner conveying member 46 for conveying toner is rotatably provided inside the second toner accommodating portion 47t of the container frame 47a.
- the position where a protrusion, a hole, etc. engage with each other is called an engagement position
- the position where engagement is released is called a non-engagement position (engagement release position).
- a second drive transmission portion (gear) 48 for receiving power for rotating the second toner conveyance member 46 is provided at one end portion in the longitudinal direction (rotation axis direction) of the second toner conveyance member 46.
- the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E indicates a direction parallel to the rotational axis direction of the second toner conveying member 46.
- the third opening 49 is provided in the center in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E on the outer peripheral surface of the container frame 47a.
- the position of the third opening 49 is not limited to a specific position as long as it is a position facing the second opening 30.
- the second shutter 53 has a shape having a curvature along the outer peripheral surface of the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E.
- the cross section of the second shutter 53 (the cross section perpendicular to the central axis of the container frame 47a) has a curved shape (substantially arc shape) along the outer periphery of the container frame 47a.
- the container frame 47a has a curved surface (substantially cylindrical shape, substantially arc shape) at least around the third opening 49.
- the second shutter 53 can rotate (revolve) around the container frame 47a along the curved surface portion (arc portion) around the third opening 49. Thereby, the second shutter 53 can open and close the third opening 49.
- the second shutter 53 has a shutter main body portion 53m (main body portion, closing portion) for closing the third opening 49.
- the second shutter 53 is provided with two snap fits having an arm portion 53a and a claw portion 53b.
- the second shutter 53 has two arm portions 53a provided at both end portions in the longitudinal direction of the shutter main body portion 53m, and two claw portions 53b respectively provided at the tips of the arm portions 53a.
- the longitudinal direction of the shutter main body 53m is substantially parallel to the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E.
- the claw portion 53b is an engaged portion (shutter side engaging portion, open member side engaging portion) for engaging with the developing unit D.
- the claw portion 53b is exposed at least on the outer diameter side (outer side) of the cylindrical container 47 (container frame 47a) (facing the outer diameter side). More specifically, the claw portion 53b is a protrusion (convex portion, protruding portion) that protrudes at least on the outer diameter side (outside) of the container 47 (container frame 47a).
- the arm portion 53a is a support portion that supports the claw portion 53b, and is a connecting portion that connects the claw portion 53b to the shutter main body portion 53m. Moreover, the arm part 53a has an elastic part (deformable part, movable part) which can be elastically deformed. That is, the arm portion 53a itself can be elastically deformed.
- the arm portion 53a extends from the rear end side of the second shutter 53 toward the front end side.
- the distal end side of the second shutter 53 means the downstream side in the direction in which the second shutter 53 moves relative to the container frame 47a when closing the third opening 49.
- the front end of the second shutter 53 is an end portion in the short direction of the second shutter 53 (a direction orthogonal to the longitudinal direction of the second shutter 53).
- the claw part 53b is configured to be movable with respect to the shutter main body part 53m by elastically deforming a part of the arm part 53a.
- Both ends in the longitudinal direction of the second shutter 53 engage with second shutter guide portions (opening / closing guides) 52 provided on both sides in the longitudinal direction of the third opening 49 in the container frame 47a.
- the second shutter is assembled along the second shutter guide portion 52 so as to be slidable in the circumferential direction on the outer peripheral surface of the container frame 47a.
- the second shutter 53 opens the third opening 49 along the outer peripheral surface of the toner cartridge E (the container open position, FIG. 5D) and closes the third opening 49. It can move between positions (container closed position, FIG. 5B).
- the third opening 49 is fully opened from the shutter main body 53m (closed portion) as shown in FIG.
- a part of the third opening 49 may be covered with the shutter body 53m (closed portion). Is possible. That is, it is only necessary that the shutter body 53m can supply at least a part of the third opening 49 and supply toner from the toner cartridge E to the developing unit D when the second shutter 53 is in the open position.
- the second shutter 53 when the second shutter 53 is in the closed position, it is desirable that all the third openings 49 are covered by the shutter main body 53m as shown in FIG. However, even if the third opening 49 is slightly opened, the third opening 49 is substantially closed by the shutter main body 53m, and the leakage of toner from the third opening 49 is sufficiently suppressed. If so, it is possible to adopt such a configuration. That is, when the second shutter 53 is in the closed position, the shutter main body 53m only needs to substantially close the third opening 49.
- the toner cartridge E is provided with insertion guide portions (guided portions, toner cartridge side guide portions) 42 and 43 at both ends in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E in the container frame 47a.
- the insertion guide portions (guided portions) 42 and 43 are guided by the insertion guide portions 35d and 36d of the developing unit D, so that the posture when the toner cartridge E is attached / detached is stabilized.
- the toner cartridge E includes an abutting portion 42a.
- the abutting portion 42a abuts against the abutted portion 35a of the developing unit D when the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D.
- the toner cartridge E includes a rotated guide portion 42b.
- the rotated guide portion 42 b guides the container frame 47 a when the toner cartridge E is rotated to open and close the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53.
- the container 47 can be smoothly rotated by the rotated guide portion 42b.
- the rotated guide portion 42b is a rotation guide (toner cartridge side rotation guide) for guiding the rotation of the toner cartridge E.
- the rotated guide portion 42b has a curved surface shape (substantially arc shape).
- the inserted guide portion 42 includes a regulated portion (a regulated surface, a posture regulating portion, an insertion direction regulating portion) for regulating the insertion posture / extraction posture (insertion direction / extraction direction) of the toner cartridge E during insertion. ) 42c1 and 42c2 are provided. As will be described later, the outer shape of the inserted guide 42 may be changed by removing a part of the outer shape.
- the inserted guide portion 43 has an abutting portion 43a that abuts against the abutted portion 36a of the developing unit D when the toner cartridge E is inserted.
- the insertion guide portion 43 also serves as a rotation guide portion (toner cartridge side rotation guide portion) that guides the container frame 47a when the abutting portion 43a opens and closes the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53. It has become.
- the abutting portion 42a, the rotated guide portion 42b, the restricting portion 42c1, and the restricting portion 42c2 are configured integrally with the inserted guide portion 42b.
- they may be provided as separate members.
- the inserted guide part 43b and the abutting part 43a may be formed of separate members. Moreover, you may provide a to-be-rotated guide part as a member different from the abutting part 43a.
- the portions of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D that are not in contact with each other may be appropriately omitted in consideration of strength and the like.
- the insertion guide portion 43 is provided at the end of the second drive transmission portion 48 at the end in the longitudinal direction of the second toner transport portion 46.
- the insertion guide portion 43 may be provided on the container frame 47a.
- the container frame 47a is provided with a grip member 44 as a handle for the user to grasp when the toner cartridge E is mounted.
- the gripping member 44 is fixed to both ends in the longitudinal direction of the container frame 47a.
- the gripping member 44 may be integrally formed with the container frame 47a.
- FIG. 1A is a side view of the toner cartridge E when the side opposite to the second drive transmission unit 48 is viewed in the longitudinal direction of the second toner transport unit 46. This figure shows the positional relationship between the gripping member 44 and the abutting portion 42 with respect to the insertion direction.
- a straight line (container frame 47a) parallel to the insertion direction f of the toner cartridge E regulated by the regulating part 42c1 and the regulating part 42c2 and passing through the abutting part 42a and the abutting part 43a. Is a straight line m).
- the gripping member 44 is installed on the downstream side of the third opening 49 (see FIG. 5D) from the straight line m in the opening direction (direction of arrow e in FIG. 1A).
- the opening direction of the third opening 49 (the direction of arrow e) is the direction in which the toner cartridge E is rotated in order to set the toner cartridge E in the developing unit D (setting direction). ⁇ 3.
- FIG. 1B is a side view of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D showing the positional relationship of the gripping member 44 and the abutting portion 43a with respect to the mounting direction of the toner cartridge E.
- FIG. 6A and 6B are schematic views showing the state of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D before the toner cartridge E is mounted (inserted).
- FIG. 6A is a perspective view and
- FIG. 6B is a side view. It is.
- FIG. 7 is a side view showing a state of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D in a state where the toner cartridge E is being mounted (inserted).
- the first shutter 37 Before the toner cartridge E is attached to the developing unit D, the first shutter 37 is in the container closed position, and the second shutter 53 is in the container closed position. Therefore, the second opening 30 of the developing unit D and the third opening 49 of the toner cartridge E are closed.
- the direction in which the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D is the direction f in FIG.
- the f direction is a direction along the surface of the restricting portion 42c when the toner cartridge E is viewed from the longitudinal side of the toner cartridge E. More specifically, it can be said that the direction in which the abutting portion 42a is on the downstream side with respect to the insertion guide portion 42 among the directions along the surface of the restricting portion 42c is the f direction.
- the user holds the holding member 44 and moves the toner cartridge E with respect to the developing unit D in the insertion direction f. At this time, the user moves the toner cartridge E so that the insertion guide portion 42 of the toner cartridge E and the insertion guide portion 35d of the developing unit D, and the insertion guide portion 43 and the insertion guide portion 36d engage with each other.
- the inserted guide portions 42 and 43 and the insertion guide portions 35d and 36d are configured so that the insertion direction f is oblique to the gravity direction g (FIG. 6B).
- the toner cartridge E is inserted in the gravitational direction g with the surface of the regulated portion 42c1 of the insertion guide portion 42 and the surface 35d1 of the insertion guide portion 35d aligned. Similarly, the toner cartridge E is inserted with the surface of the restriction portion 42c2 of the insertion guide portion 42 and the surface 35d2 of the insertion guide portion 35d being aligned.
- the insertion guide part 42 is positioned with respect to the rotation guide part 35b because the surface of the restriction part 42c1 on the lower side in the gravity direction g is on the surface 35d1 of the insertion guide part 35d.
- the attitude of the toner cartridge E with respect to the developing unit D is determined (FIG. 7).
- the user further moves the toner cartridge E downward in the gravitational direction g along the insertion guide portion 35d and the insertion guide portion 36d while keeping the posture.
- the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D along the direction of the arrow f.
- the abutting portion 42a abuts against the abutted portion 35a.
- the abutting portion 43a abuts against the abutted portion 36a.
- FIG. 8A to 8D are side views showing various configuration examples of the inserted guide portion 42, the abutting portion 42a, and the regulating portion 42c of the toner cartridge E, respectively.
- the insertion guide portion 42 of the toner cartridge E is formed by a single long round protrusion.
- FIGS. 8B to 8D may be adopted as long as the same function can be exhibited.
- a configuration in which an elongated round protrusion and a cylindrical protrusion are combined may be used.
- the surface 42d of the elongated round protrusion is brought into contact (contacted) with the surface 35d1 of the insertion guide part 35d
- the surface 42c2 of the cylindrical protrusion is brought into contact (contacted) with the surface 35d2 of the insertion guide part 35d.
- the posture when the toner cartridge E is inserted is regulated.
- the abutting portion 42a of the long round projection abuts against the abutted portion 35a, and the insertion of the toner cartridge E is completed.
- the insertion guide portion may have a configuration in which a plurality of cylindrical protrusions are combined.
- the shape of the protrusion may not be a cylindrical shape, and may be a triangular prism shape.
- the shape is not limited as long as the insertion guide portion is arranged along the insertion direction f of the toner cartridge E and can regulate the insertion posture of the toner cartridge E.
- it may be asked whether there are a plurality of inserted guide portions or a single guide portion.
- the columnar protrusions 42e and 42f aligned along the insertion direction f are aligned with the surface 35d1 of the insertion guide portion 35d. Further, the surface 42c2 of the cylindrical protrusion 42 and the surface 35d2 of the insertion guide portion 35d are combined. Thereby, the attitude of the toner cartridge E is regulated. Similarly, the columnar protrusion 42f disposed on the downstream side in the insertion direction f has an abutting portion 42a, and the abutting portion 42a abuts against the abutted portion 35a. Thereby, the insertion of the toner cartridge E into the developing unit D is completed.
- the columnar protrusions 42e and 42f aligned along the insertion direction f are respectively aligned with the surface 35d1 of the insertion guide portion 35d. Further, the columnar protrusions 42e and 42f are aligned with the surface 35d2 of the insertion guide portion 35d. Thereby, the attitude of the toner cartridge E is regulated. Further, the cylindrical protrusion 42f disposed on the downstream side in the insertion direction f has an abutting portion 42a and abuts against the abutted portion 35a, whereby the insertion of the toner cartridge E into the developing unit D is completed. .
- FIGS. 10A, 10B, 11A, 11B, and 11C the positioning of the toner cartridge E with respect to the developing unit D will be described.
- FIG. 10A is a side view of the insertion guide portion 42 of the toner cartridge E and the frame 35 of the developing unit D in a state where the abutting portion 42a and the abutted portion 35a abut.
- FIG. 10B is a cross-sectional view of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D in a state where the abutting portion 42a and the abutted portion 35a abut against each other.
- FIG. 11A is a side view of the insertion guide portion 42 of the toner cartridge E and the frame 35 of the developing unit D in a state where the toner cartridge E is positioned with respect to the developing unit D.
- FIG. 11B is a cross-sectional view showing the engagement relationship between the positioned toner cartridge E and the developing unit D. More specifically, FIG. 11B is a cross-sectional view of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D cut at the position of the second shutter 53.
- FIG. 11C is a cross-sectional view showing another engaged state of the positioned toner cartridge E and developing unit D.
- FIG. More specifically, FIG. 11C is a cross-sectional view of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D cut at the position of the claw portion 53b.
- the first shutter 37 on the developing unit side and the second shutter 53 on the toner cartridge side are opened (moved to the open position).
- the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53 are closed (moved to the closed position).
- the toner cartridge E is mounted on the developing unit D by at least a mounting operation involving a rotation operation. More specifically, the toner cartridge E is linearly inserted into the developing unit D in a straight line and then rotated and mounted on the developing unit D. The shutters 37 and 53 are moved from the closed position to the open position in conjunction with the rotation operation when the toner cartridge E is mounted.
- the toner cartridge E is removed from the developing unit D by at least a removal operation involving a rotation operation. More specifically, after rotating with respect to the developing unit D, the toner cartridge E is extracted from the developing unit D almost linearly and removed.
- the writing shutters 37 and 53 are moved to the open position in accordance with the rotation operation when the toner cartridge E is removed. (Shutter opening operation)
- FIGS. 1A, 11A, 11B, 11C, 12A, and 12B the first shutter 37 of the developing unit D and the toner The opening operation of the second shutter 53 of the cartridge E will be described.
- 12A is a side view of the insertion guide portion 42 of the toner cartridge E and the frame body 35 of the developing unit D in a state where the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 are opened.
- FIG. 12B is a cross-sectional view of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D in a state where the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 are opened.
- the relative positions of the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 can be different.
- the toner cartridge E rotates so that at least two positions (two states) can be taken.
- the first position is a non-communication position where the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 do not overlap, and the first toner storage unit 28 and the second toner storage unit 47t are in a non-communication state. In this state, the first shutter 37 is in a closed position that closes the second opening 30.
- the second position is a communication position where the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 overlap, and the first toner storage unit 28 and the second toner storage unit 47t are in communication.
- the first shutter 37 is in an open position where the second opening 30 is opened.
- the first shutter 37 is an opening / closing member that opens and closes the second opening 30.
- the third opening 49 is an opening formed in a substantially arc-shaped curved surface, and the first shutter 37 opens and closes the third opening 49 by moving (rotating) along the curved surface.
- the convex portion 45 of the container frame 47a and the hole portion 37a of the first shutter 37 are engaged.
- the front end surface 53c (see FIG. 5D) of the second shutter 53 and the collision surface (contact surface) 39 (see FIG. 4B) of the developing unit D are in opposition to each other. . That is, the insertion posture of the toner cartridge E is restricted so that the insertion guide portion 42 is guided by the insertion guide portion 35d, so that the convex portion 45 can be inserted into the hole portion 37a.
- the insertion posture of the toner cartridge E is regulated so that the front end surface 53 c faces the collision surface 39.
- the container frame 47a is rotated in the direction of arrow e by the operation of the gripping member 44 by the user.
- the engaged state between the inserted guide portion 42 and the frame 35 becomes the state shown in FIG. 12A through the state shown in FIG.
- the rotation axis of the toner cartridge E is substantially parallel to the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E.
- the container frame 47a is further rotated in the direction in which the toner cartridge E is attached to the developing unit D (the direction of arrow e in FIG. 11B). Then, the container frame 47a moves in a direction (opening direction) in which the third opening 49 for supplying toner to the developing unit is opened.
- the second shutter moves relative to the container frame 47a in the direction in which the third opening 49 is opened. More specifically, the second shutter 53 receives the force (reaction force) from the collision surface 39 on the front end surface 53c of the second shutter, so that the third opening 49 is opened along the outer periphery of the container frame 47a. Rotate (revolve) in the direction of
- the container frame 47a is formed so as to increase in height toward the arm portion 53a in a region facing the arm portion 53a on the outer peripheral surface. It has a curved surface (slope) 47b.
- the container frame 47a includes a peripheral surface whose peripheral surface protrudes toward the outer diameter side and a peripheral surface that is recessed toward the inner diameter side. A boundary portion between the peripheral surface protruding to the outer diameter side and the peripheral surface recessed to the inner diameter side is a surface 47b.
- the outer diameter side of the container frame 47a is the outer side in the rotational radius when the second shutter 53 rotates with respect to the container frame 47a.
- the outer diameter side of the container frame 47a is the side (outer side) facing outward from the container frame 47a, and is the side away from the rotation axis (center axis) of the container frame 47a.
- the outer diameter side of the container frame 47a is the side away from the second toner conveying member 46 (or the rotation axis of the second toner conveying member 46) provided inside the container frame 47a.
- the surface on which the arm 53a is moved is expressed as “a peripheral surface protruding to the outer diameter side”.
- shapes other than the “circumferential surface projecting to the outer diameter side” may be any shape that can guide the arm 53a, and the shape of the guide portion (guide portion) of the arm 53a is not intended to be specified.
- the arm portion 53a shifts from the state retracted along the concave portion provided on the peripheral surface of the container frame 47a to the state engaged with the developing unit.
- the claw portion 53b of the arm portion 53a engages with the hole portion 33 of the frame body 35 of the developing unit D (thereby, the second shutter 53 is temporarily engaged with the frame body 35).
- the surface 47b urges the claw portion 53b to remove the claw portion 53b when the second shutter 53 moves to the open position (when the toner cartridge E is mounted).
- This is a moving part (engaging position moving part) that moves to the radial side (outside of the container frame 47a), that is, the claw part 53b moves to the engaging position for engaging with the hole 33 by the surface 47b.
- the claw portion 53b moves away from the outer side of the container frame 47a (the side away from the center (rotation axis) of the container frame 47a), that is, from the rotation axis of the second conveying member 46 provided inside the container frame 47a. Move in the direction.
- the surface 47b is also a guide part that guides (guides) the claw part 53b, the arm part 53a, and the claw part 53b to the outer diameter side (that is, the engagement position) of the container frame 47a. It is also an urging portion (pressing portion) for urging and pressing to the side.
- the surface 47b is an engagement position holding portion that holds the engagement portion (claw portion 53b) at the engagement position (position where the hole 33 is engaged) when the second shutter 53 is in the open position. Since the surface 47 b supports the snap fit (the arm portion 53 a or the claw portion 53 b), the claw portion 53 b does not move to the retracted position where it is retracted from the hole portion 33.
- the first toner storage portion 28 and the second toner storage portion 47 communicate with each other via the third opening 49 and the second opening 30. Become. Thereby, the opening operation of the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 is completed.
- the movement of the toner cartridge E in the y direction and the reverse direction k of the insertion direction f by the force received from the developing unit D is restricted.
- the second drive transmission unit 48 of the toner cartridge E is connected to the drive transmission unit 38 of the developing unit D.
- the driving force for rotating the second toner conveying member 46 can be transmitted from the developing unit D.
- the toner t can be distributed (supplied) from the second toner container 47t of the toner cartridge E to the first toner container 28 of the developing unit D.
- the drive transmission unit 38 that transmits driving to the second drive transmission unit 48 of the toner cartridge E is provided on the developing unit D side.
- a drive transmission portion 38 that meshes with the second drive transmission portion 48 may be provided on the toner cartridge E side as in an embodiment described later. Note that the meshing between the gears is referred to as meshing, and even when a belt or the like provided with a protrusion is engaged, it is regarded as meshing. (Switching from toner cartridge insertion operation to shutter release operation)
- FIG. 9A is a side view showing the relationship of forces acting on the toner cartridge E when the insertion into the developing unit D is completed.
- FIG. 9B is a side view showing a force relationship acting on the toner cartridge E in another configuration example of the abutting portion 42a.
- the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D by the user, and the abutting portion 42a and the abutted portion 35a abut against each other.
- force F1 and force F2 act on the toner cartridge E.
- a force F1 applied when the user inserts the toner cartridge E acts on the grip member 44, and an equivalent force F2 acts on the abutting portion 42a of the inserted guide portion 42 as a reaction.
- a straight line (imaginary line) m that passes through the rotation axis of the toner cartridge E (the rotation center of the second shutter member 53) S and is parallel to the mounting direction of the toner cartridge E is considered.
- the length of the arm from the virtual line m to the gripping member 44 is r1
- the length of the arm from the rotation axis (rotation center) S to the abutting portion 42a is r2.
- the rotation direction of the toner cartridge E (container frame 47a) when opening the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 is such that the toner cartridge E is placed in the container frame 47a.
- the direction of the counterclockwise arrow e is obtained.
- the gripping member 44 is provided on the downstream side in the rotational direction e with respect to the straight line m.
- F3 ⁇ r3 is a moment in the opening direction e of the second opening 30 and the third opening 49. Therefore, the moment M is increased, and the container frame 47a is easily rotated in the opening direction e. The same effect can be obtained even if the positional relationship between the abutting portion 42 a and the gripping member 44 described above is applied to the relationship between the abutting portion 43 a and the gripping member 44.
- FIG. 64 shows a state in which the toner cartridge E is projected onto a projection plane perpendicular to the rotation axis S, and the toner cartridge E is divided into two regions R1 and R2 by a virtual line m.
- the gripping member 44 is located in the same region R1 as the third opening (discharge port) 49.
- the entire gripping member 44 is located in the region R1. That is, both the tip part (gripping part) 44t and the root part 44s of the gripping member 44 are located in the region R1. In particular, it is desirable that the tip part (operation part, grip part) 44t directly gripped by the user is on the region R1 side.
- the root portion of the gripping member 44 is a connection portion between the container 47 and the gripping member 44.
- a convex portion (container side protrusion, opening / closing member moving portion) 45, a claw portion 53a (opening / closing member side engaging portion), and a surface (engaging position moving portion) 47b are also on the region R1 side.
- the convex portion 45 and the claw portion 53a, the surface 47b, the third opening portion 49, and the gripping member 44 related to the opening / closing operation of the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53 are all arranged in the region R1. This simplifies the configuration related to the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53 and leads to miniaturization of the toner cartridge E and the developing cartridge D.
- the toner cartridge E is divided into four by the virtual line m and the virtual line n.
- the virtual line n is a straight line passing through the rotation center S and perpendicular to the virtual line m.
- the toner cartridge E is divided into four regions: a castle R1a, a region R1b, a region R2a, and a region R2b. That is, the region R1a, the region R1b, the region R2a, and the region R2b are arranged in this order along the arrow e direction.
- the arrow e direction is a direction in which the second shutter 53 rotates from the open position to the closed position with respect to the container 47.
- the gripping member 44 (tip portion 44t, root portion 44s) and surface (engagement position moving portion) 47b are disposed in the same region R1a as the third opening 49.
- the convex portion 45 is arranged in a region R1b on the downstream side of the region R1a in the direction of the arrow e.
- the claw portion 53a is disposed between the convex portion 45 and the gripping member 44 in the direction of arrow e.
- claw part 53a is located in the virtual line n vicinity. Although most of the claw portion 53a is disposed on the region R1b side, the claw portion 53a can be disposed on the region R1a.
- the closing operation 53 will be described.
- the closing operation of the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53 is performed by the operation opposite to the opening operation described above.
- the closing direction of the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53 is the clockwise direction of the container frame 47a when viewed from the opposite side to the installation side of the second drive transmission portion 48 (see the arrow h in FIG. 12 (b)). Direction).
- the user holds the holding member 44 and rotates the container frame 47a in the closing direction (arrow h direction / closing direction). Then, the surface 45 b of the convex portion 45 of the container frame 47 a abuts against the surface 37 a 2 of the hole portion 37 a of the first shutter 37. Thereby, the first shutter 37 receives a force from the surface 37a2 and rotates in conjunction with the rotation operation of the container 47. Then, the first shutter 37 moves to a closed position that closes the second opening 30.
- the surface 45b of the convex portion 45 is a closing force applying portion that applies a force to the first shutter 37 and moves the first shutter 37 to the closed position.
- the claw portion 53b of the second shutter 53 is arranged at the engagement position by the surface 47b as described above, and the claw portion 53b and the hole portion of the developing unit D are disposed. 33 is engaged. Therefore, the surface 53f of the claw portion 53b hits the surface 33a of the hole portion 33, and the second shutter 35 does not rotate with the container frame 47a. That is, the claw portion 53b engages with the hole portion 33, and the rotation of the second shutter 35 is restricted by the surface 53f receiving a force from the surface 33a. In other words, the second shutter 35 does not move integrally with the container frame 47a, and the second shutter 35 and the container frame 47a can move relative to each other. Therefore, the second shutter 53 moves relative to the container frame 47 a and moves to a closed position that closes the third opening 49.
- the claw portion 53b is a shutter side engaging portion that can receive a force to move the second shutter 53 to the closed position by engaging with the hole portion (receiving device side engaging portion) 33 when in the engaging position.
- the surface 53 f of the claw portion 53 b that contacts the hole portion 33 is a force receiving portion that receives a force from the hole portion 33.
- the claw portion 53b of the second shutter 53 engaged with the hole portion 33 of the developing unit D has the surface 53e along the surface 47b of the container frame 47a so that the inner diameter side (radius) of the container frame 47a is increased. Move inward). That is, the claw portion 53b retreats from the position (engagement position) engaged from the hole portion 33 along the surface 47b and moves to the retreat position. This is the state shown in FIGS. 1 (a) and 1 (b).
- the outer circumference of the container frame 47a is different in diameter from the surface 47b.
- the diameter of the container frame 47a gradually decreases along the surface 47b. Therefore, the shape of the arm portion 53a that has been elastically deformed to the outer diameter side is restored by the container frame 47a. That is, the elastic deformation of the arm portion 53a is eliminated and the arm portion 53a moves to the inner diameter side.
- the surface 47b is a guide portion that guides (guides) the movement of the claw portion 53b toward the inner diameter side of the container frame 47a. That is, the surface 47b guides the claw portion 53b from the retracted position to the engaged position when the second shutter 53 moves from the closed position to the open position (when the toner cartridge E is mounted). Conversely, when the second shutter 53 moves from the open position to the closed position (when the toner cartridge E is removed), the claw portion 53b is guided (guided) from the engagement position to the retracted position.
- the surface 47b is a surface that forms a recess that is recessed toward the inner diameter side of the container frame 47a, and a clearance (escape portion) that allows the claw portion 53b to move toward the inner diameter side of the container frame 47a is formed by the surface 47a. Is done. That is, the surface 47b is also an allowance portion that allows the claw portion 53b to move to the retracted position.
- the inner diameter side of the container frame 47a is the inner side in the rotational radius when the second shutter 53 rotates with respect to the container frame 47a.
- the inner diameter side is the side (inner side) toward the inside of the container frame 47a, and is the side closer to the rotation axis (center axis) of the container frame 47a.
- the inner diameter side is a side closer to the second conveying member 46 (or its rotation axis) provided inside the container frame 47a.
- the amount of movement measured along the radial direction of the container frame 47a is 1.3 mm or more. It was made to become. Since the claw portion 53b is moved in the radial direction by 1.3 mm or more, the claw portion 53b can reliably switch between the state in which the claw portion 53b is engaged with the hole portion 33 and the state in which the engagement is released. it can.
- the claw portion 53b is configured to move in the radial direction of the container frame 47a (the rotational radius direction of the second shutter 53), but it is not essential that the claw portion 53b move in parallel with the radial direction. Instead, it may be moved in a direction intersecting the radial direction.
- the claw portion 53b may move at least in the radial direction with respect to the shutter main body portion 53m.
- the claw portion 53b may also move in the axial direction of the container frame 47a (the rotation axis direction of the second shutter 53).
- the claw portion 53b may move in the circumferential direction of the container frame 47a (the rotation direction of the second shutter 53) with respect to the shutter main body portion 53m.
- the gripping member 44 When the toner cartridge E is inserted in the mounting position of the developing unit D, the gripping member 44 is viewed from the rotation axis of the container frame 47a, and the imaginary line that passes through the rotation center and extends in the insertion direction f.
- the container frame 47a is located downstream in the rotational direction.
- the grip member 44 is configured to receive a force for rotating the container frame 47a by a user operation.
- This position is a position where a moment that acts to rotate the container frame 47a relative to the developing unit D is generated when the gripping member 44 receives a force acting in the insertion direction f.
- the toner cartridge E has a force (FIG. 9, arrow R) acting on the gripping member 44 when the container frame 47a is rotated at this position.
- a component force (FIG. 9, arrow Rf) is included.
- the force in the insertion direction f acts on the gripping member 44 even when the container frame 47a rotates following the insertion of the toner cartridge E into the mounting position. Will continue.
- the insertion operation is changed to the rotation operation. Force conversion is performed smoothly. Therefore, the user can intuitively operate the insertion of the toner cartridge E into the developing unit D and the opening operation of the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53, and the operability can be greatly improved.
- the gripping member (handle) 44 when viewed in the direction of the rotation axis of the container frame 47a, the gripping member (handle) 44 is closer to the rotation center than the abutting portion 42a when the toner cartridge E is in the mounting position. It is configured to receive force at a distant position.
- the container frame 47a when the container frame 47a is rotated, the container frame 47a is rotated with a small force by the lever principle against the sliding resistance between the abutting portion 42a, the abutted portion 35a, and the rotation guide 35b. Can do. The same applies to the sliding resistance between the abutting portion 43a, the abutted portion 36a, and the rotation guide 36b.
- the second shutter 53 is configured to be rotatable around the container 47 (container frame 47a).
- the second shutter 53 can be opened and closed by an operation in which the toner cartridge E rotates with respect to the developing unit D (receiving device).
- the space required for opening and closing the second shutter 53 (compared to the case where the second shutter 53 is opened and closed by linear movement of the toner cartridge E) ( There is an advantage that the space) can be reduced.
- the toner cartridge E rotates with respect to the developing unit D, the toner cartridge E only changes its posture, and the center (rotation axis) of the toner cartridge E hardly moves with respect to the developing unit D. That is, the area occupied by the toner cartridge E in the developing unit D during the opening / closing operation of the second shutter 53 hardly changes. As a result, it is not necessary to provide a large space in the developing unit D for opening and closing the second shutter 53. That is, by adopting the toner cartridge E as in this embodiment, it is possible to reduce the size of the receiving device (developing unit D) that receives the toner cartridge E and the image forming apparatus provided with the receiving device.
- the engaging portion (claw portion 53b) of the second shutter 53 is moved in accordance with the rotation operation of the toner cartridge E. That is, the engaging portion moves to an appropriate position at the timing of the rotation operation of the toner cartridge E. As a result, the engaging portion does not hinder attachment / detachment in the process of attaching / detaching the toner cartridge E.
- the engaging portion can close the opening / closing member in the process of removing the toner cartridge E.
- the engaging portion is moved by the rotation operation of the toner cartridge E.
- the engaging portion is moved using the rotation operation of the toner cartridge E. Therefore, a mechanism for transmitting a driving force from the apparatus main body to the toner cartridge in order to move the engaging portion is unnecessary. That is, the configuration of the toner cartridge E, the developing unit D, and the image forming apparatus can be simplified. (Modification)
- the arm part (support part) 53c itself has an elastic part that can be elastically deformed, and the claw part (engagement part) 53b moves from the engagement position to the retracted position by the elastic force of the arm part 53c itself.
- the elastic part may be provided as a separate member (separate member) from the support part (arm part 53c) and the engaging part (claw part 53b).
- the arm portion 53c support portion
- the arm portion 53c is attached to the shutter main body portion 53m so as to be slidable and rotatable.
- the arm portion 53c is biased to the retracted position by an elastic portion (elastic member) separate from the arm portion 53c.
- the entire second shutter 53 including the shutter main body 53m, the arm 53a, and the claw 53b is integrally formed of resin.
- the second shutter 53 may be configured by combining different members.
- a metal leaf spring metal member
- the tip of the leaf spring is bent to form the shutter side engaging portion (claw portion 53b), or a member separate from the leaf spring serving as the shutter side engaging portion is fixed to the tip of the leaf spring.
- the arm portion 53a may be configured by combining a plurality of members such as resin and metal.
- FIG. 13A is a side sectional view showing the positional relationship between the holding member 44 of the toner cartridge E installed in the image forming apparatus A and the optical path of the laser light L when forming the electrostatic latent image.
- FIG. 13B is an upper cross-sectional view showing the positional relationship between the gripping member 44 of the toner cartridge E installed in the image forming apparatus A and the irradiation range of the laser light L when forming the electrostatic latent image.
- laser light L (light for forming a latent image on the photosensitive drum 16) passes through an opening formed between the grip member 44 and the container frame 47a.
- the gripping member 44 is provided such that an operation unit (gripping unit) 44b that is gripped and operated by the user extends in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E. Both ends in the longitudinal direction are configured to be fixedly supported (integrated molding) with respect to the container frame 47a by the support portion 44a. Therefore, the toner cartridge E has a structure in which a space is provided between the operation unit 44b parallel to the rotation axis S of the gripping member 44 and the container frame 47a.
- the laser light L of the laser scanner 1 passes through the space (communication portion) between the operation portion 44b of the gripping member 44 and the container frame 47a. This saves space inside the device.
- the gripping member 44 is brought down to the rotation limit, and the shutters are in the open positions where the shutters are in the open position.
- the operation portion 44b of the gripping member 44 is configured to be in a position that does not block the optical path of the laser light L.
- the support portion 44a of the grip member 44 is configured to support the operation portion 44b at a position outside the irradiation range (scanning range) of the laser light L in the longitudinal direction. ing. Accordingly, the toner cartridge E can be efficiently installed in the image forming apparatus A without impairing the user operability. Therefore, space saving is achieved, and the image forming apparatus A can be downsized.
- the lower surface of the operation unit 44b when mounted is configured to be substantially parallel to the surface formed when the laser beam is scanned.
- the lower side of the handle is parallel to the laser with respect to the plane contacting the peripheral surface of the bottle at the base of the handle.
- the lower surface of the handle on the downstream side in the mounting direction is farther from the peripheral surface of the bottle than the lower surface of the handle on the upstream side of the opening with respect to the mounting direction.
- FIG. 15A is a side sectional view schematically showing a state in which the developing unit D and the toner cartridge E are separately separated.
- FIG. 15B is a side sectional view schematically showing a state in which the toner cartridge E is installed (mounted) in the developing unit D.
- the toner cartridge (developer container) E includes a container frame 47a provided with a second toner storage portion (container storage chamber) 47t for storing the toner t. Further, the container frame 47a includes a third opening (container opening) 49 that communicates the inside and outside of the second toner accommodating portion 47t on the peripheral surface thereof. Similarly, a second shutter (container shutter) 53 capable of opening and closing the third opening 49 is movably attached to the peripheral surface of the container frame 47a. Further, the second toner conveying member 46 is rotatably supported in the second toner accommodating portion 47t of the container frame 47a. The second toner conveying member 46 conveys / discharges the toner accommodated in the second toner accommodating portion toward the third opening 49.
- the toner cartridge E including these is configured to be detachable from the developing unit D.
- the container frame 47a can rotate around a rotation axis parallel to the developing roller axial direction z with respect to the developing unit D (frame 35) in a state where the toner cartridge E is installed (attached) to the developing unit D (relative). It is configured to be movable).
- the developing unit (container) D includes a developing roller (developer carrier) 24 and a developing blade (regulating member) 25 as developing means. Further, the developing roller 24 and the developing blade 25 are assembled to a frame (developing frame) 35 of the developing unit D.
- the frame body 35 includes a first toner accommodating portion (container accommodating chamber) 28 that accommodates toner t, a developing chamber 31, a first opening 29 that communicates the developing chamber 31 and the first toner accommodating portion 28, and a first toner.
- a second opening (housing opening) 30 that communicates the inside and outside of the housing 28 is provided. The second opening 30 is provided at a position facing the third opening 49 of the toner cartridge E attached to the developing unit D.
- a first shutter (container shutter) 37 that can open and close the second opening 30 is movably assembled to the frame 35.
- a first toner conveying member 27 is rotatably supported in the first toner storage portion 28 of the frame 35.
- the developing roller 24 is rotatably provided on the frame body 35 so that a part of the peripheral surface is exposed in the developing chamber 31.
- a communication portion 58 is formed by the third opening 49 of the toner cartridge E and the second opening 30 of the developing unit D.
- the first toner storage unit 28 and the second toner storage unit 47t communicate with each other through the communication unit 58.
- the second toner conveying member 46 rotatably supported in the second toner accommodating portion 47t of the toner cartridge E rotates in the direction of the arrow u1.
- the toner t accommodated in the second toner accommodating portion 47t of the toner cartridge E passes through the third opening 49 and is sent out of the second toner accommodating portion 47t.
- the toner t sent out from the toner cartridge E through the third opening 49 is sent from the second opening 30 into the first toner accommodating portion 28 of the developing unit D through the communication portion 58.
- the toner t is sent out to the developing chamber 31 through the first opening 29 by the rotation of the first toner conveying member 27 rotatably supported in the first toner accommodating portion 28 in the direction of the arrow u2.
- the developing chamber 31 is provided with a developing roller 24 incorporating a magnet roller 26.
- the developing roller 24 attracts the toner t in the developing chamber 31 to the surface of the developing roller 24 by the magnetic force of the magnet roller 26.
- the developing blade 25 is disposed so as to elastically contact the developing roller 24 with a certain contact pressure. Then, as the developing roller 24 rotates in the direction of arrow b, the amount of toner t adhering to the surface of the developing roller 24 is regulated, and a triboelectric charge is imparted to the toner t. As a result, a toner layer is formed on the surface of the developing roller 24.
- the developing roller 24 to which a voltage is applied from the image forming apparatus A (not shown) rotates in the arrow b direction, whereby the toner t is supplied to the developing area of the photosensitive drum 16.
- the toner t is transferred according to the electrostatic latent image on the photosensitive drum 16 to make the electrostatic latent image visible, and a toner image is formed on the photosensitive drum 16.
- the developing roller 24, the first toner conveying member 27, and the second toner conveying member 46 are rotationally driven when power is transmitted from a power source such as a motor (not shown) provided in the apparatus main body. (Shutter configuration of developing unit and toner cartridge)
- FIG. 16 is an exploded perspective view of the toner cartridge E near the third opening.
- FIG. 17 is a perspective view illustrating the shutter opening / closing operation of the toner cartridge E.
- FIG. 17A shows the shutter closed state
- FIG. 17B shows the shutter open state.
- FIG. 18 is an exploded perspective view of the vicinity of the second opening of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 19 is an exploded perspective view showing the shutter opening / closing operation of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 19A shows the shutter closed state
- FIG. 19B shows the shutter open state.
- FIG. 24A is a cross-sectional view of the frame 48 of the toner cartridge E shown in FIG.
- FIG. 24B is a cross-sectional view of A2 of the frame 33 of the developing unit D shown in FIG.
- the toner cartridge E includes a container frame 47a, a third opening 49 provided in the container frame 47a, a second shutter 53, and a second seal member 157.
- the container frame 47 a includes a guide part 50 a and a guide part 50 b for guiding the second shutter 53.
- the second shutter 53 is provided with a guided portion 154a and a guided portion 154b which are respectively guided by the guide portion 50a and the guide portion 50b provided on the container frame 47a.
- the guided portion 154a and the guided portion 154b provided in the second shutter 53 are inserted into the gap 50a1 and the gap 50b1 between the outer portion 47a1 of the container frame 47a, the guide portion 50a, and the guide portion 50b.
- the second shutter 53 opens the third opening 49 provided in the container frame 47a (the container open position, FIG. 17B), and the closed state (the container opening the third opening 49). It can be moved between a closed position and FIG.
- the developing unit D includes a frame body 35, a second opening 30 provided in the frame body 35, a first shutter 37, and a first seal member 32.
- the frame body 35 is provided with a guide portion 34 a for guiding the first shutter 37 and an opening / closing guide portion 34 b.
- the first shutter 37 is provided with a guided portion 37s and a guided portion 37t that are respectively guided by a guide portion 34a and an opening / closing guide portion 34b provided on the frame body 35.
- the guided portion 37s and the guided portion 37t provided in the first shutter 37 are inserted into the gap 34a1 and the gap 34b1 between the outer portions 35a and 35b of the frame body 35 and the open / close guide portions 34a and 34b.
- the first shutter 37 is in an open state in which the second opening 30 provided in the frame 35 is opened (accommodating body open position, FIG. 19B), and in a closed state in which the second opening 30 is closed (accommodated). It can be moved between the body closed position and FIG. 19 (a)).
- FIG. 20 is a schematic side sectional view showing a configuration around the opening in a state where the toner cartridge E is engaged with the developing unit D.
- FIG. 20A is a state where the opening is closed, and FIG. b) shows a state in which the opening is opened.
- FIG. 21 is a perspective view of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D.
- FIG. 22 is a schematic cross-sectional view showing the hole 33L and the protrusion 56a, and the hole 33R and the protrusion 56b when the developing unit D and the toner cartridge E are engaged.
- FIG. 23 is a schematic sectional side view showing the shutter portion in a state where the toner cartridge E is engaged with the developing unit D.
- the second shutter member 53 has a shutter main body (closing portion) 53m for closing the third opening 39 as in the first embodiment.
- a shutter main body 53m for closing the third opening 39 as in the first embodiment.
- arm portions (connecting portion, supporting portion, elastic portion, deformable portion, movable portion) 56c and 56d respectively.
- the claw portions 56a and 56b correspond to the claw portion 53b in the first embodiment.
- the arm portions 56c and 56d correspond to the arm portion 53a in the first embodiment. Differences from the first embodiment will be described later.
- the third opening 49 provided in the toner cartridge E and the third opening 49 provided in the developing unit D are provided.
- the two openings 30 are not at the opposite positions.
- a protrusion (container engaged portion) 56a provided on the second shutter 53 of the toner cartridge E, and the frame of the developing unit D
- the hole 33L provided in the body 35 faces (engages).
- a protrusion (container engaged portion) 56b provided on the second shutter 53 of the toner cartridge E and a hole 33R provided on the frame 35 of the developing unit D face (engage).
- protrusions (container engaging portions) 45a and 45b provided on the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E face (engage) holes 37aL and 37aR provided on the first shutter 37 of the developing unit D. .
- Example 1 when the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D, the claw portion (shutter side engaging portion) 53b of the second shutter member 53 does not enter the hole portion 33 (FIG. 1A). reference). That is, the claw portion 53b enters the hole portion 33 for the first time by rotating the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E (see FIG. 11C).
- the convex portions (claw portions, shutter side engaging portions) 56a and 56b of the second shutter 53 are connected to the developing unit D. It is the structure which approachs into the hole part 33 (33R, 33L).
- shutter side engaging portions (claw portions 56a and 56b) of the present embodiment develop the force for moving the second shutter 53 from the closed position to the open position and the force for moving from the open position to the closed position. Receive from unit D. This will be described below. (Opening operation)
- the toner cartridge E is installed at a predetermined mounting position of the developing unit D. Then, by rotating the toner cartridge E, the third opening 49 of the toner cartridge E is changed from the closed state (non-communication position, FIG. 17A) to the open state (communication position, FIG. 17B). Can do. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 20, the user rotates the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E around the point F in the direction of the arrow k1.
- the second shutter 53 is restricted by the hole 33L and the hole 33R provided in the frame 35 of the developing unit D and does not move.
- the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E and the second shutter 53 move relatively, and the third opening 49 provided in the container frame 47a is exposed from the second shutter 53 and opened.
- the claw portions 56a and 56b provided on the second shutter 53 receive a force from the hole 33 (33L and 33R) of the developing unit, so that the second shutter 53 moves relative to the container frame 47a.
- the second shutter 53 is rotationally moved from the open position at which the third opening 49 is at least partially opened using the force received by the claws 56a and 56b to the closed position at which the third opening 49 is substantially closed.
- the container frame 47a rotates around the point F in the direction of the arrow k1. With this rotation, the downstream surface 45a1 in the arrow k1 direction of the protrusion 45a provided on the container frame 47a pushes the downstream surface 37aL1 in the arrow k1 direction of the hole 37aL provided in the first shutter 37 in the direction of arrow c1. Similarly, the downstream surface 45b1 in the arrow k1 direction of the protrusion 45b provided on the container frame 47a pushes the downstream surface 37aR1 in the arrow k1 direction of the hole 37aR provided in the first shutter 37 in the direction of arrow c1.
- the first shutter 37 changes the second opening 30 of the developing unit D from the closed state to the open state in accordance with the rotational displacement of the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E in the direction of the arrow k1.
- the first toner accommodating portion 28 of the developing unit D and the second toner accommodating portion 47t of the toner cartridge E are formed by a part of the second opening 30 and the third opening 49. It communicates via the communication part 58 formed.
- the toner t can be supplied from the second toner container 47t of the toner cartridge E to the first toner container 28 of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 24C is an A3 sectional view shown in FIG. 20B, and is a sectional view when the second opening 30 of the developing unit D and the third opening 49 of the toner cartridge E communicate with each other. It is.
- the guide portions 50a and 50b provided on the container frame 47a are attached to the frame 35 of the developing unit D as shown in FIG. They are inserted into the provided gaps 34a1 and 34b1, respectively.
- the open / close guide portions 34a and 34b provided in the frame 35 of the developing unit D are inserted into the gaps 50a1 and 50b1 provided in the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E.
- the closing operation for changing the second opening 30 of the developing unit D and the third opening 49 of the toner cartridge E from the communication state (FIG. 20B) to the closing state (FIG. 20A) is an opening operation. It works in the opposite direction. That is, when the user operates the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53 in the reverse direction to move them to the open state, the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E rotates about the point F in the direction of the arrow k2 ( FIG. 20 (b)). At this time, as shown in FIG. 23, the protrusion 45a provided in the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E and the hole 37aL provided in the first shutter 37 of the developing unit D are in an engaged state. Similarly, the protrusion 45b provided on the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E and the hole 37aR provided on the first shutter 37 of the developing unit D are in an engaged state.
- the downstream side surface 45a2 of the protrusion 45a in the arrow k2 direction is indicated by the arrow k2 provided on the first shutter 37.
- the direction downstream surface 37aL2 is pushed in the direction of the arrow c2.
- the downstream side surface 45b2 in the arrow k2 direction of the protrusion 45b pushes the downstream surface 37aR2 in the arrow k2 direction of the hole 37aR provided in the first shutter 37 in the arrow c2 direction.
- the first shutter 37 of the developing unit D moves in the direction of the arrow c2.
- the first shutter 37 of the developing unit D changes the second opening 30 from the open state to the closed state (FIGS. 14D and 20A).
- the second shutter 53 of the toner cartridge E closes the third opening 49 as described below.
- the protrusion 56a provided on the second shutter 57 is a hole provided in the developing unit D as shown in FIG. It is in the state engaged with 33L. Further, the protrusion 56 b provided on the second shutter 57 is engaged with the hole 33 ⁇ / b> R provided on the developing unit D.
- the second shutter 57 does not move when the container frame 47a rotates due to the protrusions 56a and 56b being locked in the holes 33L and 33R. Therefore, the third opening 49 provided in the container frame 47a moves to a position facing the second shutter 57, and the third opening 49 is closed.
- the protrusions 56a and 56b provided on the second shutter 53 are shutter-side engaging portions (force receivers) that engage with the holes 33L and 33R to receive the force to move the second shutter 57 to the closed position. Part). That is, the protrusions 56a and 56b engage (hang) with the holes 33L and 33R, and the movement of the second shutter 57 is regulated by receiving force from the holes 33L and 33R, and the second shutter 57 is controlled by the container. It moves relative to the frame 47a. That is, when the second shutter 53 rotates along the outer periphery of the container frame 47a, the second shutter 53 moves from an open position at which at least a part of the third opening 49 is opened to a closed position at which the third opening 49 is substantially closed. .
- the point Q of the surface 47b is separated from the protrusions 56a, 56b. Since the surface 47b has a stepped shape with respect to the point Q, when the point Q is separated from the protrusion 56a, the state where the surface 47b elastically deforms the arm 56c is eliminated, and a part of the protrusion 56a is removed. Retracts from the hole 33L. That is, the protrusion 56a moves from the engagement position to the retracted position by the elastic force of the arm 56c.
- the protrusions 56a and 56b do not restrict the removal of the toner cartridge E.
- the protrusion 56a and the protrusion 56b move to the engagement position and the retreat position along the surface 47b of the container frame 47a.
- the surface 47b is a guide portion that guides the protrusions 56a and 56b from the retracted position to the engaged position when the second shutter 47 moves to the open position.
- the surface 47b is a guide portion that guides the protrusion 56a and the protrusion 56b from the engagement position to the retracted position when the second shutter 47 moves to the closed position.
- FIG. 14 is a cross-sectional view schematically showing the configuration around the communicating portion 58 of the developing unit D and the toner cartridge E in this embodiment.
- FIG. 14A is a diagram showing a state where the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 are in a position where they overlap each other. In this state, the first toner storage portion 28 of the developing unit D and the second toner storage portion 47 t of the toner cartridge E are in communication with each other via the communication portion 58. In this state of communication, the toner t can be conveyed from the toner cartridge E to the developing unit D.
- FIG. 14B is a view showing a state in which the container frame 47a is rotationally displaced with respect to the frame 35 from the state of FIG. In this state, the region where the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 overlap each other is small.
- FIG. 14C is a diagram showing a state in which the container frame 47a is further rotationally displaced with respect to the frame 35 from the state of FIG. In this state, the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 are positioned so as not to overlap each other, and the communication portion 58 is closed (disappeared). In this state, the first shutter 37 does not completely close the second opening 30. Similarly, the second shutter 53 does not completely close the third opening 49.
- FIG. 14D is a diagram showing a state in which the container frame 47a is further rotationally displaced with respect to the frame 35 from the state of FIG. 14C. In this state, the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 53 completely close the second opening 30 and the third opening 49, respectively. In this state, the toner cartridge E can be detached from the developing unit D.
- FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram illustrating a configuration when the communication unit 58 is viewed from the first toner storage unit 28 side.
- the width of the third opening 49 in the displacement direction k2 of the container frame 47a is the second opening. It is configured to be narrower than 30.
- movement of the container frame 47a is called a displacement direction.
- the downstream end of the third opening 49 in the displacement direction is configured to be positioned upstream of the downstream end of the second opening 30. That is, when the toner t is conveyed and supplied through the communication portion 58, the space area formed by the second opening 30 in the communication portion 58 is antigravity with respect to the space area formed by the third opening 49.
- the structure is open in the direction. A space formed by expanding the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 on the second opening 30 side of the communication part 58 is the collection part 30a.
- the upstream surface (upstream end) 49a of the third opening 49 of the frame body a of the toner cartridge E below the gravitational direction G has the second opening 30 of the developing unit D below the gravitational direction. It is a sloped surface. That is, the upstream surface 49a is a surface region facing the direction of the arrow u1 (the rotation direction of the container frame 47a) on the end surface of the third opening 49, and the first toner storage portion 28 (second opening 30) side is the first. It is inclined so as to fall below the direction of gravity G from the side of the two toner containing portion 47.
- the toner t in supplying the toner t from the second toner storage portion 47t to the first toner storage portion 28, the toner t reaches the communication portion 58 to the full height of the third opening 49. Assume a supply state that is buried (above the gravity direction G). The toner t supplied from the second toner storage portion 47t to the first toner storage portion 28 via the communication portion 58 passes through the communication portion 58 in the order of the third opening portion 49 to the second opening portion 30. Therefore, the height of the interface is regulated by the third opening 49 that is lower than the second opening 30. As shown in FIG.
- the toner t when the toner t is filled up to the height of the third opening 49, the toner t is transported from the second toner storage chamber 47t to the first toner storage chamber 28 even if the second toner transport member 46 is rotated. Not.
- the collection unit 30 a is provided upstream (upward) in the direction of gravity G with respect to the third opening 49. For this reason, the toner t does not exist in the collection unit 30a.
- the container frame of the toner cartridge E is used.
- the body 47a is moved in the direction of arrow k2 (the first shutter 37 is in the direction of arrow c2).
- the upstream surface 49a of the container frame 47a in the moving direction (arrow k2 direction) attracts the toner t present in the communication portion 58 while collecting the toner t.
- the frame 47a moves, it moves (rises) in the direction of the arrow k2.
- the upstream surface 49a of the third opening 49 reaches the same height as the recovery part 30a of the second opening 30 as shown in FIG. To do. This height is higher than the interface height of the toner t regulated by the downstream surface facing the upstream surface 49a of the third opening 49 in the communication state of FIG.
- the upstream surface 49a of the third opening 49 has an arrow gy line segment parallel to the gravitational direction G at this height, and is perpendicular to the second segment and from the second toner containing portion 47t. Inclined in the direction of the arrow g line segment combined with the arrow x line segment toward one toner storage unit 28.
- the toner t scraped upward by the upstream surface 49a of the third opening 49 passes through the recovery unit 30a, which is a space formed above the toner t interface of the second opening 30 due to the inclination of the upstream surface 49a. Then, it is moved and stored in the first toner storage unit 28.
- the toner t attracted by the upstream surface 49a of the third opening 49 enters the collection unit 30a before the upstream surface 49a reaches the vicinity of the first seal member 32 beyond the height of the collection unit 30a. Then, the toner t is collected into the first toner storage unit 28 (see FIG. 14C). Therefore, the toner t is suppressed from adhering to the surface 32a of the first seal member 32. That is, the toner t can be prevented from entering between the first seal member 32 provided in the developing unit D and the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E.
- FIG. 25 shows a developing unit D1 that does not have a collection unit 30a and a toner cartridge E1 corresponding to the developing unit D1.
- the developing unit D1 has a second opening 930 formed by the developing frame 935, and the toner cartridge E1 has a third opening 949 formed by the frame 947a.
- the size and shape of the second opening 930 and the third opening 949 are substantially the same.
- a container 947t for toner t is formed by the frame body 947a.
- the toner does not pass through the communication portion 958 and upstream of the third opening 949. It may remain on the surface 949a (see FIG. 25B).
- such leakage of the toner t can be suppressed by using the collection unit 30a.
- the toner t moves in the k2 direction by the rotation of the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E in the k2 direction. Accordingly, leakage to the outside of the frame 35 of the developing unit D and the container frame 47a of the toner cartridge E can be suppressed.
- the second opening when viewed from the direction orthogonal to the shutter movement direction, the second opening is configured to be wider on the downstream side of the shutter movement direction than the third opening.
- the toner can be prevented from leaking to the outside of the opening at the time of closing.
- it is not necessary to take a countermeasure such as providing the sealing member with a capturing portion (concave portion) for capturing the toner. Therefore, the leakage of the toner (developer) when replacing the toner cartridge can be more effectively suppressed with a simpler configuration without requiring an increase in the size of the seal member or the like.
- recovery unit 30a has been described using the present embodiment, the recovery unit 30a is also provided in the developing unit D in the first and second embodiments (see FIGS. 3 and 13A). (Other)
- the collection portion 30a is formed by making the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 different in size.
- the present invention is not limited to such a configuration.
- the second opening 30 and the third opening 49 are positioned at positions shifted from each other, thereby forming the collection portion 30a and partially overlapping the region. You may comprise so that the communication part 58 may be formed.
- the size and shape of each opening are not limited to specific ones.
- the shape of each opening part was made into the rectangle, respectively, as long as an appropriate collection
- the shape of the upstream surface 49a of the 3rd opening part 49 is set in the displacement direction with respect to the 2nd opening part 30 of the 3rd opening part 49 rather than the edge of the container inside side in the upstream surface 49 in the upstream side 49. It was made to incline so as to be located on the downstream side.
- the present invention is not limited to the above configuration.
- the third opening 49 is displaced with respect to the second opening 30 when the communication part 58 is closed. At this time, various shapes are adopted as long as the upstream end of the third opening 49 in the displacement direction generates a force for pushing the toner from the third opening 49 to the second opening 30. You can do it.
- the collecting unit 30a is not essential for the developing unit D. That is, it is possible to adopt a configuration without the collection unit 30a as shown in FIG. That is, in FIG. 25, when the toner cartridge E1 is removed from the developing unit D1, the toner in the normal toner cartridge E1 and the developing unit D1 is consumed, and there is little toner in the toner cartridge E1 and the developing unit D1. At this time, there is not much toner in the communication portion 358, and even when the collecting portion 30a is not provided, there is a low possibility that the toner leaks when the toner cartridge E1 is removed.
- the configuration in which the collection unit 30a is provided as in the present embodiment is more preferable because toner leakage can be more reliably suppressed with a simple configuration. Even when the toner cartridge E is removed while the toner remains in the toner cartridge E, toner leakage can be suppressed.
- the developing unit D may be provided with a collection unit as in this embodiment.
- a configuration related to opening / closing of the shutter will be described in detail.
- the shape of the second shutter 253 having the snap fit portion 271 and the configuration for guiding the second shutter 253 will be described in detail.
- a drive transmission mechanism for improving the sealing performance provided at the end of the container frame (frame body, cylindrical portion) 247g constituting the second toner storage portion 247t will also be described.
- a conveyance configuration capable of stably supplying the toner t in the toner cartridge E to the developing unit D will also be described.
- the developing unit D is formed into a cartridge integrally with the drum unit C and the developing unit D is a part of the process cartridge (see FIGS. 29A and 29B).
- the developing unit D may constitute a single cartridge, or the developing unit D may be fixed to the apparatus main body.
- the process cartridge is a receiving device that receives the toner cartridge E.
- the part of the developing unit D which is a part of the process cartridge, may be particularly called a receiving device.
- the configuration of the main body of the image forming apparatus is substantially the same as in the other embodiments, and will be omitted, and will be described sequentially from the vicinity of the receiving portion of the toner cartridge E of the developing unit D. ⁇ 1. [Detailed explanation of the toner cartridge receiving area of the development unit]
- the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D refers to the axial direction of the developing roller 224 of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 29 is a perspective view of the developing unit D as seen from the receiving portion side of the toner cartridge E.
- FIG. FIG. 29A shows a state where the second opening (reception port) 230 is closed (the first shutter 237 is in the closed position), and
- FIG. 29B shows a state where the second opening 230 is opened (the first shutter). 237 represents an open position).
- FIG. 30 is an enlarged perspective view of the vicinity of the receiving portion of the toner cartridge E of the developing unit D.
- 30A shows a state where the second opening 230 is closed (the first shutter 237 is in the closed position)
- FIG. 30B shows a state where the second opening 230 is opened (the first shutter 237). Represents the open position).
- FIG. 31 is a cross-sectional view showing the vicinity of the second opening 230 of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 31A is a cross-sectional view seen from the driving side
- FIG. 31B is a cross-sectional view seen from the non-driving side.
- the developing unit D includes a second opening 230 and a first shutter 237 in the vicinity of the toner cartridge receiving portion.
- the second opening 230 and the first shutter 237 are provided at a substantially central portion in the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D.
- the position of the second opening 230 is not limited to a specific position as long as it is a position facing a third opening (discharge port) 249 described later.
- the position of the first shutter 237 is not limited to the central portion as long as it can cover the second opening.
- the second opening 230 is sealed by a first shutter 237 having a curvature along the outer peripheral surface of a toner cartridge E described later.
- the first shutter 237 has a hole 237 a that engages with a convex portion (container-side protruding portion, opening / closing member moving portion) 245 (see FIG. 32) provided in a toner cartridge E, which will be described later, to seal the second opening 230. It is provided outside the range.
- the first shutter 237 is engaged with and guided by first shutter guide portions 234 provided at both ends in the longitudinal direction of the second opening 230.
- the first shutter 237 has a first shutter guide portion between a closed position (FIG. 29A) for closing the second opening 230 (FIG. 29A) and an open position for opening (FIG. 29B). 234 is configured to be slidable along 234.
- a first lock arm (receiving device side lock member) 261 is provided between the first shutter guide portion 234 and the second opening portion 230 in the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D (see FIG. 30B). ).
- the first lock arm 261 is a mechanism that prevents the first shutter 237 from opening unintentionally.
- the first lock arm 261 has a claw portion 261a.
- the claw portion 261 a of the first lock arm 261 is located at the same position as the hole portion 237 a of the first shutter 237 in the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D.
- a first sealing seal 232 that seals between the first shutter 237 and the second opening 230 is provided near the second opening 230 of the developing unit D.
- the first sealing seal 232 is attached so as to surround the second opening 230.
- an insertion guide (non-) 235d and an insertion guide (drive) 236d for guiding the insertion locus of the toner cartridge E are provided.
- the developing unit D includes an abutting part (non-) 242a, an abutting part (non-drive) 243a (see FIG. 32) of the toner cartridge E, an abutting part (non-) 235a, and an abutting part (drive) 236a. Is provided.
- a side on which a driving unit such as a gear (for example, the first drive transmission unit 238) is disposed is referred to as a driving side.
- the side opposite to the driving side is called the non-driving side.
- (drive) means that it is arranged on the drive side.
- (Non) means arranged on the non-driving side.
- a rotation guide part (non-) 235b and a rotation guide part (drive) 236b for guiding the rotational movement of the toner cartridge E are provided.
- the insertion guide portions 235 and 236 are guides (receiving device side guide portions) for guiding the mounting and removal of the toner cartridge E.
- the insertion guide portion (non-) 235d and the insertion guide (drive) 236d are configured to have planes parallel to each other along the insertion direction f (FIG. 29A) of the toner cartridge E.
- the abutted portion (non-) 235a and the rotation guide portion (non-) 235b are provided downstream in the insertion direction f of the insertion guide portion 235d (non-). Further, the abutted portion 236a (drive) and the rotation guide (drive) 236b are provided downstream in the insertion direction f of the insertion guide (drive) 236d.
- the developing unit D includes a first drive transmission portion 238 at one end portion in the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D (FIG. 29A).
- the first drive transmission unit 238 is connected to a second drive transmission unit 248 (see FIG. 32) and a second toner transport unit 246 (see FIG. 35) via an idler gear (rotational force receiving unit) 250 of the toner cartridge E described later. Tell the drive to.
- the first drive transmission unit 238 is connected to the drive mechanism of the image forming apparatus main body inside the developing unit D by a gear as a transmission unit (not shown).
- the first drive transmission unit 238 is a gear (gear), and is a rotational force transmission unit that transmits a rotational force for driving the second toner conveying member 246 to the toner cartridge E.
- the idler gear 250 is a rotational force receiving portion that receives rotational force from the outside of the toner cartridge E (that is, the first drive transmission portion 238 of the developing unit D).
- the second drive transmission portion 248 is a second rotational force receiving portion that receives rotational force (driving force) from the idler gear 250.
- an unlocking claw 262 for releasing the lock of the second shutter 253 and a shutter holding part 263 are provided in the vicinity of the second opening 230 of the developing unit D. Further, the shutter holding portion 263 has a lock hole 263a.
- the lock release claw 262 releases a second lock arm 270 that prevents the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E, which will be described later, from opening unintentionally (see FIG. 34).
- the shutter holding portion 263 is in contact with the claw portion (first engagement portion) 271a or the projection portion (second engagement portion) 271b of the snap fit portion 271 provided on the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E described later. (See FIG. 42). Accordingly, when the second shutter 253 is closed, the second shutter 253 is prevented from being rotated around a container (developer storage container, toner storage container) 247 described later.
- FIG. 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, and 37 the detailed configuration of the toner cartridge E according to the present embodiment will be described with reference to FIGS. 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, and 37.
- FIG. 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, and 37 the detailed configuration of the toner cartridge E according to the present embodiment will be described with reference to FIGS. 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, and 37.
- FIG. 32 is a perspective view of the toner cartridge E.
- FIG. 32A is a perspective view seen from the second drive transmission portion 248, and
- FIG. 32B is a perspective view seen from the opposite side of the second drive transmission portion 248.
- FIG. 33 is a state diagram in which the third opening 249 of the toner cartridge E is opened.
- 33A is an enlarged view of the vicinity of the third opening 249
- FIG. 33B is a cross-sectional view of the vicinity of the third opening 249 when the toner cartridge E is viewed from the non-driving side.
- FIG. 34 is a diagram of the second shutter 253.
- FIG. 35 is a view showing the relationship between the second toner conveying member 246 and the container 247.
- FIG. 35 is a view showing the relationship between the second toner conveying member 246 and the container 247.
- FIG. 35A is a diagram illustrating the shape of the sheet 246 a of the second toner conveying member 246.
- FIG. 35B is a view showing a cross section of the stirring shaft seal 264.
- FIG. 35C is an enlarged cross-sectional view showing the relationship between the second drive transmission portion 248 and the stirring shaft seal 264.
- FIG. 36 is an enlarged cross-sectional view of the hole portion 252a of the second shutter guide portion (opening / closing guide) 252 cut from the front surface of the third opening portion 29 in a state where the toner cartridge E and the second shutter 253 are assembled.
- 36A shows a state where the second shutter 253 is closed
- FIG. 36B shows a state where the second shutter 253 is opened. Note that.
- the second shutter guide portion 252 is represented by a broken line in order to explain the second lock arm 270 in an easy-to-understand manner.
- FIG. 37 is a perspective view showing a state before the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing
- the toner cartridge E includes a container 247, a third opening 249, a second shutter 253, a second seal member 254, a second drive transmission unit ( Gear) 248, idler gear 250, and stirring shaft seal 264.
- the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E refers to the rotational axis direction of the second toner conveying member 246.
- the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E is also the longitudinal direction of the container 247 and the second shutter 253.
- the container 247 rotates.
- the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E is the rotational axis direction of the container 247.
- the second shutter 253 is configured to open and close the opening by rotating around the container 247.
- the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E is also the rotational axis direction of the second shutter 253.
- the container 247 has a hollow and substantially cylindrical shape. That is, the frame (container frame 247g) constituting the main body portion (main part) of the container 247 has a substantially cylindrical shape.
- the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E is the generatrix direction of the cylinder or the central axis direction of the cylinder.
- the container frame 247g has a flat surface portion and at least a curved surface portion (arc portion) having a substantially cylindrical shape (substantially arc shape) around the third opening 249 (see FIG. 33B and the like).
- the second shutter 253 rotates along the curved surface portion, and opens and closes the third opening 249.
- the container frame (cylindrical portion) 247g is a hollow body and forms a toner accommodating portion (toner accommodating chamber) 247t that accommodates toner.
- the container 247 includes a convex portion (container-side protrusion, container-side convex portion) 245 that engages with the hole 237a of the first shutter 237 described above on the outer periphery of the container frame 247g. Further, the container 247 (container frame 247g) has an abutting surface 247c that abuts against an abutted surface 237b (see FIG. 30) of the first shutter 237 in the process of opening and closing the first shutter 237.
- the abutting surface 247c is a surface formed by a step portion provided on the frame body (container frame body 247g) of the container 247 and intersecting the rotation direction of the toner cartridge E (the rotation direction of the second shutter 252). . This is an elongated surface extending in the longitudinal direction (axial direction) of the toner cartridge E.
- the abutting surface 247c is an opening force applying portion (opening / closing member moving portion) that applies a force for opening the first shutter 237 to the first shutter 237 to move the first shutter 237 to the open position.
- the abutting surface 247c is disposed in the vicinity of the tip of the second shutter 253 (shutter body 253m) when the second shutter 253 is located at the closed position.
- the second toner container 247t is provided with a second toner transport member 246 for transporting toner. Further, one end of the second toner conveying member 246 is rotatably held by the container 247 and the other end thereof is rotatably supported by a second drive transmission unit 248 for driving the second toner conveying member 246.
- the stirring shaft seal 264 has a hollow cylindrical shape, and the outer diameter d1 thereof is slightly larger than the inner diameter d2 of the container frame 247g. Further, the inner diameter d3 of the stirring shaft seal 264 is formed slightly smaller than the outer diameter d4 of the cylindrical portion 248b of the second drive transmission portion 248.
- the natural width w1 of the stirring shaft seal 264 is such that the seal crushing surface 248a of the second drive transmission portion 248 and the container frame 247 are sealed when the second drive transmission portion 248 is positioned on the container frame 247g. It is larger than the distance w2 with the abutting surface 247f.
- the agitation shaft seal 264 is installed in the container frame 247g of the container 247 so as to be sandwiched between the seal crushing surface 248a of the second drive transmission unit 248 and the seal abutment surface 247a of the container 247.
- an idler gear 250 is installed so as to be able to transmit the drive with the second drive transmission member 248.
- the second drive transmission unit 248 and the idler gear 250 of the present embodiment are formed in a helical gear shape, and the second drive transmission unit 248 is inward in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E during drive transmission (the direction of the arrow r4 in FIG. 35C). ).
- the second toner conveying member 246 includes a conveying shaft 246a and a flexible sheet member 246b.
- the sheet member 246b is provided with a slit for bringing the toner stored in the second toner storage portion 247t of the container 247 to the third opening 249 (see FIG. 35A). A detailed configuration will be described later.
- the third opening 249 is provided at the center in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E on the circumference of the container 247 (container frame 247g).
- the position of the third opening 249 is not limited as long as it is provided at a position facing the second opening 230 of the developing unit D.
- second shutter guide portions 252 for guiding the movement of the second shutter 253 are provided at both ends in the longitudinal direction of the third opening 249 of the toner cartridge E. Yes. Also, as shown in FIGS. 32B and 36, a hole 252a is provided in a part of the second shutter guide portion 252.
- the main body portion (shutter main body portion 253m) of the second shutter 253 has a shape having a curvature along the outer peripheral surface of the toner cartridge E. That is, the second shutter 253 (shutter body 253m) has a curved surface shape (substantially an arc shape) along the container 247.
- the container 247 (container frame 247g) has a curved surface (substantially cylindrical shape, substantially arc shape) around the third opening 249 (see FIG. 33B).
- the second shutter 253 can reciprocate along the curved surface portion (arc portion) of the container 247 provided around the third opening 249. That is, the second shutter 253 rotates (revolves) around the container 247. As a result, the second shutter 253 can open and close the third opening 249.
- the second shutter 253 has a second lock arm (arm portion) 270 on the outer side in the longitudinal direction (axial direction) with respect to a second sealing seal 254 to be described later, and both end portions on the outer side in the longitudinal direction with respect to the second lock arm 270. Includes a snap fit portion (arm portion) 271.
- the second lock arm 270 is disposed between the shutter main body portion 253m and the snap fit portion 271 and extends from the rear end side of the shutter main body portion 253m to the front end side.
- the second lock arm also has an elastic portion and can be elastically deformed.
- the two snap fit portions 271 are coupled to both ends of the main body portion (shutter main body portion 253m) of the second shutter 253.
- the two second lock arms 270 are connected to both ends of the shutter main body 253m, respectively.
- the shutter main body 253m is a portion (closing portion) for substantially closing the third opening 249.
- the snap fit portion 271 is configured to be movable with respect to the shutter main body portion 253m by being deformed.
- the second lock arm 270 is also configured to be movable with respect to the shutter main body 253m by being deformed.
- the snap fit portion 271 may be formed of resin integrally with the shutter main body portion 253, or may be formed of a member (for example, a metal leaf spring) different from the shutter main body portion 253m.
- the second lock arm 270 includes an abutting surface 270a that abuts against the unlocking claw 262 (see FIG. 30) of the developing unit D. Further, the second lock arm 270 includes a claw portion 270b that fits into the hole 252a (see FIG. 32) of the second shutter guide portion 252 of the toner cartridge E.
- the second lock arm 270 is also formed of resin integrally with the shutter main body 253m. However, the second lock arm 270 may be formed by attaching a member (for example, metal) different from the shutter main body 253m. .
- the abutted surface 270a of the second lock arm 270 is an inclined portion (inclined surface) that is inclined toward the side closer to the shutter main body portion 253m as it goes toward the distal end side of the second lock arm 270.
- the claw portion 270 b is a protrusion (projection) that protrudes at least toward the outside in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E.
- the snap fit portion 271 includes an arm portion 271c that elastically deforms in the longitudinal direction of the second shutter 253 and the toner cartridge E.
- the snap fit portion 271 is provided on the distal end side of the arm portion 271c, and a claw portion (protrusion portion, convex portion, first engagement portion) protruding in the outer diameter direction (radially outer side) of the second shutter 253. 271a.
- the claw portion 271a and the projection portion 271b are engaging portions (opening / closing member side engaging portions) for engaging with the developing unit D.
- the claw portion 271a (or the protruding portion 271b) is coupled to the shutter main body portion 253m by the arm portion 271c of the snap fit portion 271 (see FIG. 34).
- the arm portion 271c of the snap fit portion 271 is a connecting portion for connecting the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b to the shutter main body portion 253.
- the arm part 271c of the snap fit part 271 is a support part for supporting the engaging part (the claw part 271a and the protruding part 271b).
- the arm portion 271c has an elastic portion that can be elastically deformed. That is, the arm portion 271c can be elastically deformed.
- the snap fit portion 271 extends from the rear end side of the shutter main body portion 253m toward the front end side.
- the front end side of the shutter main body 253 corresponds to the downstream side in the rotation direction (movement direction) in which the second shutter 253 rotates from the open position to the closed position.
- the rear end side of the shutter main body 253 corresponds to the upstream side in the rotation direction.
- the claw portion 271a protrudes at least in the outer diameter direction of the container 247 (the outer diameter direction of the second shutter 253).
- the outer direction of the second shutter 253 is also the outer diameter direction of the container 247 and also the outer side of the rotation radius direction in the rotation locus of the second shutter 253.
- the outer diameter direction is a side (outside of the container 247) toward the outside of the container 247, and is a side away from the rotation axis (center axis) of the container 247 or the container 247.
- the outer diameter direction is the second toner transport member 246 or the side away from the rotation axis of the second toner transport member 246.
- the protrusion 271b is a protrusion that protrudes at least in the circumferential direction of the container 247 (the rotation direction of the second shutter 253). More specifically, in the rotation direction (opening direction) in which the second shutter 253 moves from the closed position to the open position with respect to the container 247, the protruding portion 271b protrudes toward the downstream side.
- the second shutter 253 has a claw portion (first engagement portion) 271a and a projection portion (second engagement portion) 271b as engagement portions, and the claw portion 271a and the projection portion 271b are in mutually different directions (each other It protrudes in the crossing direction).
- the snap fit portion 271 (arm portion 271c) becomes wider as it approaches the tip side. That is, on the end side in the longitudinal direction of the second shutter 253, the snap fit portion 271 is provided with the first regulated surface 271d, the second regulated surface 271e, and the third regulated surface 271f.
- the first regulated surface 271d is an inclined surface (inclined portion) that is inclined toward the outer side in the longitudinal direction toward the distal end side of the arm portion 271c.
- the second and third regulated surfaces 271e and 271f are surfaces substantially parallel to the direction in which the arm portion 271c extends. The distance between the regulating surface 271e and the regulating surface 271f is larger than the width on the rear end side (root side) of the arm portion 271c.
- first and second regulated surfaces 271d and 271e are in contact with a first regulating surface 247d (FIG. 33A) of the container 247 described later.
- the third regulated surface 271f contacts the second regulating surface 247e (FIG. 33A) of the container 247.
- the second shutter 253 is engaged with the second shutter guide portion (opening / closing guide) 252 of the toner cartridge E.
- the container 247 is between the state where the third opening 249 is closed along the outer peripheral surface of the toner cartridge E (FIG. 32A) and the state where the third opening 249 is opened (FIG. 32B). It is configured to be slidable along the circumferential direction.
- the claw portion 270b of the second lock arm 270 engages with the hole portion 252a provided in the second shutter guide portion 252 of the toner cartridge E. Do (fit). Further, the surface 270c of the claw portion 270b and the surface 252b of the hole 252a of the second shutter guide portion 252 abut. As a result, the movement of the second shutter 253 relative to the container 247 is restricted, and the second shutter 253 is prevented from opening unintentionally.
- the claw portion 270b is a lock portion that locks the second shutter 253 in the closed position.
- the claw portion 270b is connected to the shutter main body portion 253m by the second lock arm 270. That is, the second lock arm 270 (more precisely, the rear end side of the second lock arm 270 than the claw portion 270b) is a connecting portion that connects the claw portion 270b to the shutter main body portion 253m and supports the claw portion 270b. It is also a support part.
- the toner cartridge E includes an insertion guide portion (non-) 242 and an insertion guide portion (drive) 243 at both ends in the longitudinal direction.
- the inserted guide portion (non-) 242 and the inserted guide portion (drive) 243 are respectively guided by an insertion guide (non-) 235d and an insertion guide (drive) 236d of the developing unit D (see FIG. 37).
- the inserted guide portions 242 and 243 are toner cartridge side guides.
- the insertion guide (non) 235d, the insertion guide (drive) 236d of the developing unit D, the insertion guide portion (non) 242 of the toner cartridge E, and the insertion guide portion (drive) 243 will be described with reference to FIGS.
- the peripheral portion and similar portions of the gripping member 244 will be briefly described. Note that these detailed operations, operations, and functions are substantially the same as those in the third embodiment, and thus description thereof is omitted.
- the inserted guide portion (non-) 242 includes an abutting portion (non-) 242a and a rotated guide portion (non-) 242b.
- the abutting portion (non-) 242a abuts against the abutted portion (non-) 235a of the developing unit D when the toner cartridge E is inserted.
- the periphery of the abutting portion (non-) 242a is a rotated guide portion (rotary guide on the toner cartridge side) having a curved surface shape (substantially arc shape).
- the inserted guide part (drive) 243 includes an abutting part (drive) 243a.
- the abutting portion (drive) 243a abuts against the abutted portion (drive) 236a of the developing unit D when the toner cartridge E is inserted.
- the inserted guide portion (non-) 242 is provided with a restriction portion 242c1 and a restriction portion 242c2 as posture restriction portions for restricting the insertion posture (extraction posture) of the toner cartridge E at the time of insertion.
- the restriction portion 242c1 and the restriction portion 242c2 are insertion direction restriction portions (mounting direction restriction portion, extraction direction restriction portion, removal direction restriction portion) for restricting the insertion direction (mounting direction) and the extraction direction (extraction direction) of the toner cartridge E. But there is.
- the container 247 is provided with a grip member 244 as a handle for the user to grasp when the toner cartridge E is mounted.
- the gripping member 244 has a U shape fixed at both ends in the longitudinal direction of the container 247.
- the gripping member 244 is provided with fixed portions 244a at both ends of the operation portion 244b that the user grips and operates. Further, the fixing portion 244a has a U shape fixed to the second toner container 247 at both ends in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E. Note that the shape of the gripping member 244 is not limited to this as long as the user can grip it. ⁇ 2. [Shutter opening / closing operation when attaching / detaching the toner cartridge to / from the developing unit]
- FIG. 28 is a diagram showing a series of movements of the second shutter 253 until the third opening 249 is exposed and a positional relationship in the vicinity of the snap fit portion 271.
- FIGS. 28A and 28D are enlarged views around the second shutter 253 showing a state in which the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D.
- FIG. FIG. 28A is a view of the second shutter 253 viewed from the front
- FIG. 28D is a cross-sectional view of the third opening 249 viewed from the non-driving side. 28B, the toner cartridge E is further rotated from the state of FIG.
- FIG. 28A in the direction in which the third opening 249 is exposed, and the front end surface 253c of the second shutter 253 and the collision surface 239 of the developing unit D are It is the enlarged view of the 2nd shutter 253 periphery which showed the state which faced.
- 28B and 28E are views of the second shutter 253 viewed from the front, and FIG. 28E is a cross-sectional view of the third opening 249 viewed from the non-driving side.
- 28 (c) and 28 (f) show a state in which the second opening 230 and the third opening 249 are in communication with each other by further rotating FIG. 28 (b) and the mounting of the toner cartridge E is completed.
- FIG. 28C is a view of the second shutter 253 viewed from the front
- FIG. 28F is a cross-sectional view of the third opening 249 viewed from the non-driving side.
- FIG. 38A is a cross-sectional view of the first lock arm 261 of the developing unit D as seen from the non-driving side, immediately before the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D.
- FIG. 38B and FIG. 38C are cross-sectional views of the first lock arm 261 of the developing unit D as viewed from the non-driving side when the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D.
- FIG. 39 shows the movement of the second lock arm 270 of the second shutter 253 when the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D by cutting the hole 252a of the second shutter guide portion 252 from the front of the second shutter 253.
- FIG. 39A is a view showing a state immediately after the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D.
- FIG. 39B is a diagram showing a state in which the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D, and the toner cartridge E is further rotated in the direction in which the third opening 249 is exposed.
- FIG. 40 is a view specifically showing the positional relationship in the vicinity of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 until the third opening 249 is exposed.
- FIG. 40A is a diagram showing the relationship between the snap fit portion 270 and the shutter holding portion 263 in the states of FIGS. 28B and 28E.
- FIG. 40C is a diagram showing a relationship between the snap fit portion 270 and the shutter holding portion 263 in the states of FIGS. 28C and 28F.
- FIG. 40B is a diagram showing the relationship between the snap fit portion 270 and the shutter holding portion 263 at the timing between FIG. 40A and FIG. 40C.
- FIG. 40D is a diagram showing the relationship between the snap fit portion 270 and the first restricting portion 247d of the container 247 in the state of FIG.
- FIG. 40 (e) is a diagram showing the relationship between the snap fit portion 270 and the first restricting portion 247 d of the container 247 in the state of FIG. 40 (b).
- FIG. 40 (f) is a diagram showing the relationship between the snap fit portion 270 and the first restricting portion 247 d of the container 247 in the state of FIG. 40 (c).
- FIG. 41 is a view showing the vicinity of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 in the state shown in FIGS. 28 (c) and 28 (f).
- FIG. 42 is a view showing a state where the movement of the second shutter 253 is restricted by the developing unit D when the front end surface 253c of the second shutter 253 and the collision surface 239 of the developing unit D abut against each other.
- FIG. 42A is a view showing a longitudinal relationship between the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 and the lock holding portion 263 of the developing unit D.
- FIG. FIG. 42B is a view showing the positional relationship in the rotational direction between the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 and the toner cartridge E of the lock holding portion 263 of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 43 is a view seen from the drive side showing the positional relationship between the first drive transmission portion 238 of the developing unit D and the idler gear 250 in the process of mounting the toner cartridge E.
- FIG. 43A shows that the second shutter 253 is closed when the toner cartridge E is inserted
- FIG. 43B shows that the mounting of the toner cartridge E is completed and the second shutter 253 is open.
- FIG. 44 is a cross-sectional view of the vicinity of the second opening 230 and the third opening 249 viewed from the drive side in the state of FIG. 43 (b). 39, 40 (a), 40 (b), and 42, other thin parts related to the description of the operation of the second lock arm 270 and the snap fit portion 271 are simplified.
- the convex portion 245 of the container 247 engages with the hole portion 237a of the first shutter 237 in a state where the toner cartridge E is positioned in the developing unit D.
- the surface 245c of the convex portion 245 of the container 247 contacts the surface 261c of the first lock arm 261.
- the first lock arm 261 receives the force F11 from the convex portion 245 of the container 247 and elastically deforms in the direction of the arrow r1.
- the claw portion 261a of the first lock arm 261 is detached (disengaged) from the hole portion 237a of the first shutter 237.
- the first shutter 237 is released from the restriction in the direction of arrow e due to the contact between the surface 237a2 of the hole 237a and the surface 261b of the first lock arm 261, and is movable relative to the second opening 230. It becomes.
- the convex portion 245 is a lock release portion that contacts (engages) the hole portion 237a with the first lock arm 261 and releases the locked state of the first shutter 237.
- the insertion posture and the insertion direction are regulated so that the convex portion 245 engages (enters) the hole 237a and contacts the first lock arm 261. . That is, the orientation and insertion direction of the toner cartridge E with respect to the developing unit D are regulated by the inserted guide portion (non-) 242 and the insertion guide (non-) 235d.
- the second lock arm 270 is elastically deformed in the direction of the arrow r2 (the inner side in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E) by F12x which is a component force of the force F12.
- F12x which is a component force of the force F12.
- the claw portion 270b of the second lock arm 270 is disengaged from the hole portion 252a of the second shutter guide portion 252. That is, by the force received by the abutment surface 270a from the unlocking claw 362, the claw portion 270b unlocks from the lock position (FIG. 39 (a)) that locks the second shutter 253 to the closed position (FIG. 39).
- the abutting surface 270a is an unlocking force receiving portion that receives a force that moves the claw portion 270b (locking portion) from the developing unit D when the toner cartridge E rotates when the toner cartridge E is mounted.
- the abutting surface 270a is an inclined portion (inclined surface) that inclines toward the inner side in the longitudinal direction as it approaches the distal end side (the distal end side of the second lock arm 270) of the second shutter 253. Since the abutting surface 270a is inclined, the force (F12) received from the unlocking claw 262 has a component (F12x) that acts on the inner side in the longitudinal direction.
- the second shutter 253 can move relative to the third opening 249 of the container 247 in the direction of arrow e. More specifically, the second shutter 253 rotates relative to the container 247 when the front end surface 253c of the second shutter 253 receives a force from the collision surface (force applying portion) 239 of the developing unit D. Rotates from the closed position to the open position.
- the front end surface 235c of the second shutter 253 is an opening force receiving portion for receiving a force for moving the second shutter 253 from the closed position to the open position from the outside of the toner cartridge E (that is, the developing unit D).
- the second shutter guide part 252 is also a cover part that covers the second lock arm 270 (claw part 270b).
- the unlocking claw 662 of the developing unit D enters between the second shutter guide portion 252 and the container frame 247g.
- the unlocking claw 662 is engaged with the second shutter guide portion 252.
- the claw portion 271a of the snap fit portion 271 is positioned on the outer side in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E with respect to the shutter holding portion 263 of the developing unit D in a state where the front end surface 253c and the collision surface 239 are in contact with each other (FIG. 42 ( a)).
- the claw portion 271a of the snap fit portion 271 has an arrangement relationship as shown in FIG. 42B with respect to the lock hole 263a of the shutter holding portion 263 of the developing unit D. That is, the claw portion 271a is positioned downstream of the lock hole 263a in the rotation direction of the toner cartridge E when opening the third opening 249 (the direction of arrow e in FIG. 42B). (Operation of the first shutter and the second shutter)
- FIG. 28 operations of the first shutter 237 and the second shutter 253 when the toner cartridge E is further rotated will be described with reference to FIGS. 28, 40, and 42.
- FIG. 28 operations of the first shutter 237 and the second shutter 253 when the toner cartridge E is further rotated will be described with reference to FIGS. 28, 40, and 42.
- the abutting surface 237b (see FIG. 30) of the first shutter 237 abuts against the abutting surface 247c of the container 247 (see FIGS. 32 and 38).
- the first shutter 237 is pushed by the container 247 and receives the force F13 in the rotation direction of the toner cartridge E.
- the first lock arm 261 that restricts the movement of the first shutter 237 is unlocked with respect to the developing unit D.
- the first shutter 237 rotates integrally with the container 247 in the direction in which the second opening 230 is opened (direction of arrow e in FIG. 28). Then, the first shutter 237 moves in the order of FIG. 28 (d) ⁇ FIG. 28 (e) ⁇ FIG. 28 (f).
- the front end surface 253c of the second shutter 253 abuts against the collision surface 239 of the developing unit D. Therefore, when the container 247 rotates, the container 247 moves relative to the second shutter 253.
- the first regulated surface 271d of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 abuts on the point 247h of the first regulating surface 247d of the container 247 and a force F14 (inward in the longitudinal direction). Power).
- the snap fit portion 271 is elastically deformed so that the arm portion 271c of the snap fit portion 271 is inward in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E (direction approaching the third opening 249, the direction of the arrow r3 in FIGS. 28 and 40D). To do.
- FIGS. 28C, 40 ⁇ / b> D, and 40 ⁇ / b> E are diagrams illustrating a state in which the second regulated surface 271 e of the snap fit portion 271 and the first regulating surface 247 d of the container 247 are in contact with each other. .
- the positions of the claw portion 271a and the projection portion 271b of the snap fit portion 271 are positioned so as to overlap the shutter holding portion 263 in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E. This is a state in which the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b are located at the engagement position.
- the claw portion 271a of the snap fit portion 271 is located downstream (in the direction of arrow e) with respect to the shutter holding portion 263 of the developing unit D in the rotation direction of the toner cartridge E when the third opening portion 249 is opened. (See FIGS. 40 (c) and 42 (b)).
- the snap fit portion 271 is elastically deformed (operated) in the order of FIG. 28 (a) ⁇ FIG. 28 (b) ⁇ FIG. 28 (c).
- the first regulating surface 247d is a moving part (engaging position moving part) that moves the claw part 271a and the protruding part 271b inward in the longitudinal direction (inward in the axial direction).
- the first regulating surface 247d biases the first regulated surface 271d when the second shutter 253 moves to the open position (when the second shutter 253 rotates because the toner cartridge E is mounted).
- the claw portion 271a is moved to the engagement position for the shutter holding portion 263 by the force applied to the first restricted surface 271d from the first restriction surface 247d, and the projection portion 271b is also engaged with the lock hole 263a. To the engagement position.
- the first regulating surface 247d is a guide portion that guides the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b from the retracted position to the engaging position via the first regulated surface 271d.
- the first regulating surface 247d is an urging portion (pressing portion) that urges and presses the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b toward the engagement position via the first regulated surface 271d.
- the first regulating surface 247d biases the second regulated surface 271e toward the inside in the longitudinal direction when the second shutter 253 is located at the open position. Thereby, the first regulating surface 247d holds the engaging portions (the claw portions 271a and the protruding portions 271b) in the engaging position.
- the first regulating surface 247d is an engagement position holding portion.
- the first regulating surface 247d contacts the first regulated surface and the second regulated surfaces 271d, 271e provided on the support portion (arm portion 271c) that supports the engaging portions (claw portion 271a, projection portion 271b). Then, the engaging portion is biased through the arm portion 271c.
- the engaging portion may be biased by the first regulating surface 247d directly contacting the engaging portion (the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b).
- the engaging portions (claw portions 271a and 271b) of the second shutter 253 are moved by 2.3 mm or more inward in the axial direction by the first regulating surface 247d. That is, when the moving distance (movement amount) when the engaging portion moves from the retracted position to the engaging position is measured along the axial direction (longitudinal direction), it is 2.3 mm or more. (Operation until the second opening and the third opening communicate)
- the first shutter 237 is integrated with the container 247 and the second opening 230 is opened. It rotates in the direction (arrow e direction). Further, the container 247 moves relative to the second shutter 253. At this time, the toner cartridge E rotates in the direction of the arrow e while the second shutter guide portion 252 of the container 247 is engaged with the first shutter guide portion 234 and the movement of the container 247 in the cylindrical radial direction is roughly restricted. . Then, as shown in FIG. 28F, the opening of the second opening 230 and the third opening 249 is completed in a state where the third opening 249 and the second opening 230 are in communication.
- the idler gear 250 is not connected to the first drive transmission unit 238, and the idler gear 250 is connected only to the second drive transmission unit 248 ( FIG. 43 (a)).
- the position of the idler gear 250 in the mounting process of the toner cartridge E is located upstream of the first drive transmission unit 238 in the mounting rotation direction of the toner cartridge E (the direction of arrow e in FIG. 43). Further, when the toner cartridge E is rotated in the mounting direction (the direction of arrow e in FIG. 43) by mounting, the idler gear 250 approaches the first drive transmission unit 238.
- the idler gear 250 is configured to be connected (engaged) with the first drive transmission unit 238 in a state where the toner cartridge E is completely attached to the developing unit D. Then, drive transmission from the developing unit D to the second toner conveying member 246 becomes possible (FIG. 43B). That is, the idler gear 250 can receive the rotational force by the rotation operation of the toner cartridge E.
- the second drive transmission unit 248 and the idler gear 250 of this embodiment adopt a helical gear shape. Therefore, the second drive transmission unit 248 moves inward in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E (the direction of the arrow r4 in FIG. 35C) due to the thrust force generated during drive transmission. Therefore, the second drive transmission unit 248 is configured such that the position is determined by the positioning surface 248c of the second drive transmission unit 248 abutting the surface 247g1 of the container frame 247g during drive transmission.
- the stirring shaft seal 264 is sandwiched between the seal abutting surface 247f of the container 247 and the seal crushing surface 248a of the second drive transmission unit 248. Therefore, the stirring shaft seal 264 is compressed in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E.
- the compressed stirring shaft seal 264 can improve the airtightness of the space between the cylindrical portion 248b of the second drive transmission portion 248 and the container frame 247g of the container 247. For this reason, the toner inside the container 247 can be prevented from leaking from the vicinity of the second drive transmission unit 248 to the outside.
- a moment is generated in which the entire toner cartridge E rotates due to an external force (that is, rotational force received by the idler gear 250) received when driving is transmitted from the first drive transmission unit 238 of the developing unit D.
- the first drive transmission unit 238 of the developing unit D rotates in the direction of the arrow q in FIG.
- a moment M1 is generated in the toner cartridge E by the external force F16 received when driving is transmitted from the first drive transmitting portion 238 of the developing unit D.
- the direction of the generated moment M1 is the same as the rotation direction (arrow e) of the container 247 when the third opening 249 is opened.
- the rotation direction (arrow u) of the idler gear 250 is the same as the rotation direction (arrow e) of the container 247 when the third opening 249 of the toner cartridge E is opened.
- the rotation direction (arrow u) of the idler gear is the same as the rotation direction (arrow e direction) in which the second shutter rotates with respect to the container 247 from the open position to the closed position.
- the toner cartridge E opens the third opening 249 with respect to the developing unit D ( A rotating force acts on the arrow e).
- the rotation direction of the second drive transmission unit 248 and the second toner conveying member 246 is set so that the third opening 249 moves upward from below the gravitational direction (arrow G direction) from the viewpoint of toner conveyance (arrow in FIG. 44).
- the toner can be lifted in the d direction).
- FIG. 45A is a longitudinal sectional view showing the relationship between the shape of the sheet member 246 b of the second toner conveying member 246 and the container 247.
- FIG. 45B is a sectional view showing the relationship between the shape of the sheet member 246 b of the second toner conveying member 246 near the third opening 249 and the container 247.
- FIG. 45C is an enlarged view of a part of the slit-shaped sheet member 246b.
- FIG. 45D is a cross-sectional view showing the movement of the second toner conveying member 246 during rotation.
- the toner in the toner cartridge E is transported to the developing unit D by the second transport member 246 through the third opening 249 and the second opening 230 that are communicated with each other.
- the second conveying member 246 rotates inside the toner cartridge E by the driving force received through the first drive transmission unit 238, the idler gear 250, and the second drive transmission unit 248 of the developing unit D.
- the rotation direction of the second transport member 246 is the direction in which the third opening 249 is lifted from the bottom to the top in the gravity direction G (the direction of the arrow d in FIG. 45B).
- the sheet member 246b of the second toner conveying member 246 has a slit shape in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E (FIG. 45A).
- the slit shape of the sheet member 246b of the second toner conveying member 246 is substantially symmetrical with respect to the center of the third opening 249 on the driving side and the non-driving side.
- This slit has a shape in which the cutting direction is inclined inward in the longitudinal direction of the sheet member 246b from the center in the short direction of the sheet member 246b to the tip.
- the point 246b2 at the front end of the sheet member 246b is configured to be longer inward than the point 246b1 at the center in the lateral direction.
- the short shape in the longitudinal direction of the sheet member 246b is configured to slightly enter the container 247 in a shape along the inner shape of the container 247.
- a width w3 from the rotation center S of the second toner conveying member 246 of the sheet member 246b to the front end (246b3, 246b4) in the short direction is set.
- the width w3 was configured to be larger than w5.
- the width w4 from the rotation center S of the second toner conveying member 246 of the sheet member 246b to the front end 246b7 in the short direction is set. Further, the distance is w6 from the rotation center S of the second toner conveying member 246 of the container 247 to the point 247h2 on the inner wall surface of the container 247 in the direction orthogonal to the longitudinal direction. At this time, the width w4 was configured to be larger than w6.
- the second conveying member 246 contacts the toner inside the container 247 or the inner wall of the container 247. Then, with respect to the point 246b3 at the front end of the sheet member 246b, the point 246b4 at the front end positioned inward in the longitudinal direction is more deformed in the direction of the arrow d (see FIG. 45). The grounds will be described below with reference to FIG. 45 (c) of the sheet member 246b. In the short direction of the sheet member 246b, the points at the leading end of the sheet member 246b are point 246b3 and point 246b4. Furthermore, the point 246b4 is located closer to the third opening 249 (see FIG.
- the point 246b3 is an arbitrary point in the range of the region w30 in which the point 246b3 and the support point 246b5 coincide with each other in the longitudinal direction of the leading end sheet member 246b.
- the point 246b4 is an arbitrary point in the range of the region w30 where the point 246b4 and the support point 246b6 do not coincide with each other in the longitudinal direction of the leading end sheet member 246b.
- the sheet member 246b has a shape in which the cutting direction is inclined inward in the longitudinal direction of the sheet member 246b from the center in the short direction of the sheet member 246b to the front end, the relationship r10 ⁇ r11 is established. Therefore, when the same force is applied to the points 246b3 and 246b4, the point 246b4 having a longer distance to the support point is deformed (bends) more greatly. As a result, the sheet member 246b of the second conveying member 246 can convey the toner in the central direction in the longitudinal direction (the direction of the third opening 249). Further, the amount of toner remaining in the toner cartridge E without being discharged is reduced by raising the second conveying member 246 from the lower side to the upper side in the direction of gravity.
- the slit shape is not provided in the longitudinal direction of the sheet member 246b in the longitudinal direction wider than the third opening 249 in the vicinity of the third opening 249.
- the longitudinal width w7 of the sheet member 246b in the vicinity of the third opening 249 is larger than the longitudinal width w8 of the third opening 249. Accordingly, the sheet member 246b is prevented from entering the second opening 230 from the third opening 249 (see FIG. 45B).
- the toner near the third opening 249 is moderately scraped by the inner wall of the container 247.
- the sheet member 246b pushes the toner into the developing unit D, and the toner can be prevented from deteriorating due to aggregation of the toner in the developing unit D.
- the slit shape angle ⁇ 2 (see FIG. 45A) of the sheet member 246b is a shape inclined about 70 degrees with respect to the longitudinal direction of the sheet member 246b.
- the shape which penetrated about 1.5 mm with respect to the internal shape of the container 247 was employ
- the shape of the sheet member 246b is not limited as long as the toner in the toner cartridge E can be stably conveyed into the developing unit D.
- the toner can be stably discharged to the developing unit D even when the opening for discharging the toner is narrow.
- the size of the 1st seal member 232 can be made small by making the width
- the container 247 is a substantially cylindrical container.
- w5> w6 and the diameter (inner diameter and outer diameter) of the container 247 depends on the position. (Diameter) is different. That is, the diameter of the container 247 on the end side in the longitudinal direction is larger than the diameter of the central portion of the container 247 (that is, around the third opening 249 and the vicinity thereof). Since the second shutter 253 is attached to the central portion of the container 247, the diameter of the container 247 is reduced in order to secure a corresponding space. On the other hand, the diameter of the container 247 is increased in order to increase the volume for storing the toner.
- the diameter of the second conveying member 246 (sheet member 246b) differs depending on the position. As described above, the diameter on the axial end portion side of the second transport portion 246 is larger than the diameter of the central portion of the second transport member 246 (near the third opening 249). (Shutter closing operation)
- FIG. 46, 47, and 48 the closing operation of the first shutter 237 of the developing unit D and the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E will be described with reference to FIGS. 46, 47, and 48.
- FIG. 46, 47, and 48 the closing operation of the first shutter 237 of the developing unit D and the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E will be described with reference to FIGS. 46, 47, and 48.
- FIG. 46 is a view showing the vicinity of the convex portion 245 of the container 247 when the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E is closed.
- FIG. 46A is a cross-sectional view seen from the non-driving side.
- (B) is an enlarged cross-sectional view of the vicinity of the convex portion 245 of the container 247.
- FIG. 47 is a diagram showing a state of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 when the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E is closed.
- FIG. 47A is an enlarged view showing the longitudinal relationship between the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 and the shutter holding portion 263.
- FIG. 47B is a cross-sectional view of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 and the positional relationship in the rotation direction of the toner cartridge E of the shutter holding portion 263 as seen from the non-driving side.
- FIG. 47C is an enlarged view of the protrusion 71 b of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 and the lock hole of the shutter holding portion 263.
- FIG. 48 is a diagram illustrating a process in which the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E is closed.
- FIG. 48A is a view showing the vicinity of the snap fit portion 271 in a state where the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E is open.
- FIG. 48B is a view showing the vicinity of the snap fit portion 271 in a state where the second shutter 253 of the toner cartridge E is closed.
- FIG. 48C is a cross-sectional view of the state of FIG. 48A viewed from the non-driving side
- FIG. 48D is a cross-sectional view of the state of FIG. 48B viewed from the non-driving side. is there.
- the closing operation of the first shutter 37 and the second shutter 253 is performed in the reverse operation to the opening operation described above. Note that the closing direction of the first shutter 237 and the second shutter 253 is opposite to the rotation direction when the container 247 drives the second transport member 246 (FIGS. 46A, 47B, and 48C). ), The direction of rotation in the direction of arrow h in FIG.
- the user holds the holding member 244 and rotates the container 247 in the closing direction (arrow h direction). Then, the surface 245 b of the convex portion 245 of the container 247 abuts against the surface 237 a 2 of the hole portion 237 a of the first shutter 237. Accordingly, the first shutter 237 receives the force F18 from the surface 237a2 and rotates in conjunction with the container 247 to close the second opening 230.
- the positions of the claw portions 271a and the protrusions 271b of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 are set to the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E with respect to the shutter holding portion 263 of the developing unit D. Overlapping position in the direction. Further, as shown in FIG. 47B, the claw portion 271a of the snap fit portion 271 is downstream of the shutter holding portion 263 of the developing unit D in the direction in which the third opening portion 249 of the toner cartridge E is opened (see FIG. 47B). 47 (direction of arrow e).
- the protruding portion 271b of the second shutter 253 fits into the lock hole 63a of the shutter holding portion 263 (FIG. 47 (c)). Therefore, the second shutter 253 is regulated in the closing direction (arrow h direction) of the container 247 by the lock holding portion 262. As the toner cartridge E rotates in the direction of the arrow h, the second shutter 253 and the container 247 move relatively. As a result, the second shutter 253 closes the third opening 249 (FIG. 38 (from the state shown in FIG. 48C to the state shown in FIG. 48D)).
- the claw portion 271a protrudes at least in the outer diameter direction (the outer side in the rotational radius direction) of the second shutter 253. As a result, the claw portion 271a comes into contact (engagement) with the shutter holding portion 263 when the container 247 rotates.
- the claw portion 271a is an engaging portion (a closing force receiving portion) that receives a force for moving the second shutter 253 from the shutter holding portion 263 to the closed position.
- the movement of the second shutter 253 is restricted when the container 247 rotates by the force received by the claw portion 271a from the shutter holding portion 263. In other words, the second shutter 253 rotates relative to the container 247 by the force received by the claw portion 271a, and moves from the open position to the closed position.
- the protrusion 271b protrudes at least upstream in the arrow e (the rotation direction in which the second shutter 253 rotates from the open position to the closed position with respect to the container 247).
- the protrusion 271b can be kept engaged with the lock hole 263a when the second shutter 253 rotates from the open position to the closed position.
- the protruding portion 271b is an engaging portion (second engaging portion) that engages with the lock hole 263a, and is also an engagement maintaining portion that maintains the engaged state of the claw portion 271a and the shutter holding portion 263.
- the protrusion part 271b is a protrusion smaller than the claw part 271a. That is, the height of the protrusion 271b (height measured along the direction in which the protrusion 271b protrudes) is smaller than the height of the claw 271a (height along the direction in which the nail 271a protrudes).
- claw part 271a was 5.6 mm, and the height of the projection part 271b was 0.3 mm.
- the height of the protrusion 271b is preferably 0.1 mm or more and 0.5 mm or less.
- the first restricted surface 271d or the second restricted surface 271e of the second shutter 253 is a container until the third opening 249 is closed.
- the first regulating surface 247d and the corner portion 247h of 247 are in contact with each other.
- the first regulated surface 271d or the second regulated surface 271e of the second shutter 253 holds the position of the snap fit portion 271 in the longitudinal direction.
- the first restricting surface 247d is an engagement position holding portion that holds the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b in the engagement position.
- the third regulated surface 271f of the snap fit portion 271 contacts the second regulating surface 247e of the container 247.
- the third regulated surface 271f of the snap fit portion 271 receives a force F17 from the second regulating surface 247e of the container 247 outward in the longitudinal direction.
- the second regulated surface 271e and the first regulating surface 247d of the container 247 are not in contact with each other.
- claw part 271a and the projection part 271b of the snap fitting part 271 fall out to a longitudinal direction outer side with respect to the shutter holding
- the positions of the claw portions 271a and the protrusions 271b of the snap fit portion 271 of the second shutter 253 are located at the same positions as before the mounting with respect to the shutter holding portion 263 of the developing unit D (the state shown in FIG. 42 is obtained). ). In this state, the positioning of the toner cartridge E with respect to the developing unit D is released, and the toner cartridge E can be taken out.
- the second regulating surface 247e is a moving part (retreat position moving part) that moves the claw part 271a and the protruding part 271b to the outside in the longitudinal direction (the axial direction outside).
- the second regulating surface 247e biases the third regulated surface 271f when the second shutter 253 moves to the closed position (when the second shutter 253 rotates because the toner cartridge E is removed).
- the claw portion 271a moves to the retreat position where the engagement with the shutter holding portion 263 is released by the force applied from the second restriction surface 247e to the third restricted surface 271f.
- the protrusion 271b also moves to the retracted position where the engagement with the lock hole 263a is released.
- the second restriction surface 247e is a guide portion that guides the engagement portions (the claw portions 271a and the projection portions 271b) from the engagement position to the retracted position, and the claw portions 271a and the projection portions 271b via the third restricted surface 271f. It is an urging part (pressing part) which urges and presses toward the retreat position.
- the second restricting surface 247b is provided on the arm portion 271c that supports the engaging portions (the claw portions 271a and the protruding portions 271b) and contacts the third restricted surface 271f, thereby energizing the engaging portion.
- the second regulating surface 247b may be in direct contact with the engaging portions (the claw portions 271a and the protruding portions 271b).
- the engaging portions (the claw portions 271a and the protruding portions 271b) are moved 1.3 mm or more outward in the axial direction by the second restricting surface 247b. That is, when the movement distance (movement amount) when the engaging portion moves to the retracted position by the second regulating surface 247b is measured along the axial direction, it is set to 1.3 mm or more. Thereby, the protrusion part 271b can cancel
- the second regulating surface 247e is a retracted position holding portion that holds the engaging portion in the retracted position when the second shutter 253 is in the closed position.
- the second restricting surface 247e restricts the engagement portions (271a, protrusions 271b) from moving to the engagement position.
- the elastic force of the snap fit 271 (arm part 271c) is also used. That is, in the process in which the second shutter 253 moves from the open position to the closed position, the snap fit portion 271 moves away from the first regulating surface 247d. Then, the snap fit part 271 (arm part 271c) which has been elastically deformed tends to eliminate the deformation. At this time, the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b move to the retracted position by the movement (elastic force) of the snap fit 271.
- the container 247 is provided with a retraction position moving part (second restricting surface 247e) that acts on the snap fit part 271 to move the claw part 271a and the protrusion part 271b to the retreat position, and the claw part 271a and the protrusion part. 271b is reliably moved to the retracted position.
- the retracted position moving portion (second regulating surface 247e) may not be provided.
- the arm portion 271c As the support portion, the arm portion 271c is hardly plastically deformed and the elastic force is not easily changed. Even without the retracted position moving part (second regulating surface 247e), the claw part 271a and the projecting part 271b can be moved to the retracted position.
- an elastic member may be provided separately from the support part without giving elasticity to the support part (arm part 271c) itself.
- a support portion (arm portion) is rotatably attached to the shutter main body portion 253m.
- a torsion spring elastic member, elastic portion
- the support portion is biased to the retracted position by the force of the torsion spring.
- the second shutter 253 By configuring the second shutter 253 as described above, it is possible to reliably open and close the shutters of each other even when the toner cartridge is mounted on the developing unit by an attaching / detaching operation with rotation.
- the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b are moved in the longitudinal direction (rotation axis direction, central axis direction) of the container frame 247g with respect to the shutter main body portion 253m by the opening / closing operation of the second shutter.
- the claw portion 271a and the projection portion 271b are configured to move between the engagement position and the retracted position.
- this does not intend that the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b move only in the longitudinal direction of the container frame. That is, the moving direction of the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b is not limited to being parallel to the longitudinal direction.
- the claw portion 271a and the protruding portion 271b may move in the radial direction of the container frame body 247g and the circumferential direction of the container frame body.
- the claw portion 271a and the projection portion 271b move between the retracted position and the engaged position, they also move in the circumferential direction of the container 247 with respect to the shutter main body portion. That is, the claw portion 271a and the protrusion portion 271b move to the rear end side of the second shutter 253 when moving from the retracted position to the engaged position.
- the container 274 is provided with an engagement position moving portion (first restriction surface 247d) that moves the engagement portions (the claw portions 271a and the projection portions 271b) of the second shutter 253 to the engagement positions. It is a surface formed by a projection (projection).
- the retracted position moving part (second restricting surface 247e) that moves the engaging parts (the claw part 271a and the projecting part 271b) to the retracted position is formed by a projecting part (convex part) provided on the container 274. Surface.
- the engaging position moving part (first restricting surface 247d) and the retracted position moving part (second restricting surface 247e) may be formed by recesses (dents, grooves) provided in the container 274.
- recesses dents, grooves
- the side of the toner cartridge E on which the second drive transmission unit 348 is disposed is referred to as a drive side, and the other end side is referred to as a non-drive side.
- the inserted guide portion arranged on the drive side is called an inserted guide portion (drive) 343.
- the inserted guide portion disposed on the non-driving side is referred to as an inserted guide portion (non-) 342.
- the insertion guide portion arranged on the drive side is referred to as an insertion guide portion (drive) 336d.
- the insertion guide portion arranged on the non-driving side is referred to as an insertion guide portion (non-) 335d.
- FIG. 49 is a perspective view of the toner cartridge E in the present embodiment before being mounted on the developing unit D.
- FIG. FIG. 50 is a cross-sectional view showing the vicinity of the second opening 330 of the developing unit D.
- FIG. 50A is a cross-sectional view seen from the driving side
- FIG. 50B is a cross-sectional view seen from the non-driving side.
- the longitudinal direction of the developing unit D refers to a direction parallel to the axial direction of the developing roller 324 of the developing unit D.
- 51 is a perspective view of the toner cartridge E
- FIG. 51A is a perspective view seen from the second drive transmission portion 348
- FIG. 51B is a perspective view seen from the opposite side to the second drive transmission portion 348. It is.
- the insertion direction f of the toner cartridge E of the present embodiment into the developing unit D is the linear direction of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d and the insertion guide portion (non-) 335d. It is. Furthermore, the insertion direction f of the present embodiment is substantially the same as the direction in which the convex portion 345 provided on the container 347 of the toner cartridge E protrudes from the container 347 when viewed from the cross-sectional direction (J direction in FIG. 51). Direction. This is because the convex portion 345 of the container 347 needs to fit into the hole portion 337a of the first shutter 337 when the toner cartridge E is inserted into a predetermined mounting position of the developing unit D.
- the insertion guide portion (non-) 342 has an abutting portion 342a that abuts against the abutting portion 335a (see FIG. 50B) of the developing unit D when the toner cartridge E is inserted.
- the insertion guide portion (non-) 342 is a rotation guide portion that guides the container frame 347a when opening and closing the first shutter 337 (see FIG. 49) and the second shutter 353 (see FIG. 51 (a)).
- 342b is provided.
- the inserted guide portion (non-) 342 is provided with restricted portions (restricted surfaces) 342 c 1 and 342 c 2 for restricting the insertion posture / movement direction of the toner cartridge E at the time of insertion.
- the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 is provided at the end of the second drive transmission portion 348 at the end in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge E, it may be provided in the container 347. Further, the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 is provided with an abutting portion 343a that abuts against the abutted portion 336a of the developing unit D when the toner cartridge E is inserted.
- the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 is configured such that the abutting portion 343a also serves as a rotated guide portion that guides the rotation of the container frame 347a when the first shutter 337 and the second shutter 353 are opened and closed. .
- the abutting portion 342a, the rotation guide portion 342b, the restriction portion 342c1, and the restriction portion 342c2 are configured to be integrated with the insertion guide portion (non-) 342b.
- these may be provided as separate members.
- FIG. 52 is a longitudinal sectional view showing the vicinity of the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 and the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d in the present embodiment.
- FIG. 53 is a cross-sectional view showing the shapes of the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 and the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d according to another embodiment.
- the shape of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 is a cylindrical shape.
- the diameter of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 is defined as D1.
- the width of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d (the dimension measured in the direction crossing the insertion direction f of the toner cartridge E) is defined as follows. That is, during the insertion of the toner cartridge E into the developing unit D, the width of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d is w9, and the width of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d in the state where the toner cartridge E is completely installed is w10. Suppose there is.
- the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 has a role of guiding insertion when the toner cartridge E is inserted into the developing unit D. Furthermore, the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 is integrated with the second drive transmission portion 348, and when the toner cartridge E is completely inserted and transmitted, the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 transmits the second drive transmission. It rotates integrally with the part 348. Therefore, the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 has a role of an insertion guide in the insertion process of the toner cartridge E between the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d and the insertion is completed to the second drive transmission portion 348. When driving is transmitted, it is necessary to have a rotatable relationship.
- the shape of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 is a cylindrical shape, but is not limited thereto, and may be a shape as shown in FIG.
- the shape of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 shown in FIG. 53 is such that the insertion direction f of the toner cartridge E (the direction in which the convex portion 345 of the container 347 protrudes from the container 347, see FIG. 50) is the insertion guide portion (drive). ) Shorter than the width direction of 336d.
- the width of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 in the insertion direction f is w12 and the width of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 in the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d width direction is w13, the relationship of w12 ⁇ w13 is established. ing. Even in this shape, the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 is inserted between the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d and the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d while serving as an insertion guide in the insertion process of the toner cartridge E. When drive is transmitted to 348, a rotatable relationship is possible. (Relationship between inserted guide part (non) and insertion guide part (non))
- FIG. 54 is a longitudinal sectional view showing the vicinity of the inserted guide portion (non-) 342 and the insertion guide portion (non-) 335d in the present embodiment.
- the insertion guide portion (non-) 342 has a shape having a long side in the mounting direction f direction.
- the length of the long side in the mounting direction f direction of the insertion guide portion (non) 342 is w16
- the width of the insertion guide portion (non) 342 in the width direction of the insertion guide portion (non) 335d is w17
- the relationship is w16> w17.
- the width of the insertion guide (non-) 335d during the insertion of the toner cartridge E into the developing unit D is w14, the relationship is w17 ⁇ w14.
- the first shutter 337 (see FIG. 49) and the second shutter 353 see FIG.
- the width of the rotation guide portion (non-) 335b that guides the rotation of the toner cartridge E is w15.
- the relationship is w16 ⁇ w15.
- the restricted portions (restricted surfaces) 342c1 and 342c2 which are long side portions extending in the mounting direction f direction of the inserted guide portion (non-) 342, extend along the width of the insertion guide (non-) 335d.
- the insertion posture / movement direction of the toner cartridge E is regulated.
- the toner cartridge E can be mounted as in the other embodiments. ⁇ 2. [Toner cartridge end guide shape]
- FIG. 55 is a diagram in which the positions of the toner cartridge E and the developing unit D in the longitudinal direction are correct.
- the protruding length of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 from the end surface on the driving side of the second drive transmission portion 348 in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge is referred to as w18 (hereinafter referred to as the length w18 of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343). ).
- the depth of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge at this time is defined as w19 (hereinafter referred to as the depth w19 of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d).
- the protruding length from the non-driving side end portion of the container 347 in the longitudinal direction of the toner cartridge of the insertion guide portion (non) 342 is referred to as w20 (hereinafter referred to as the length w20 of the insertion guide portion (non) 342).
- the depth of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d in the toner cartridge longitudinal direction at this time is defined as w21 (hereinafter referred to as the depth w21 of the insertion guide portion (non-) 335d).
- the length w18 of the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 has a relationship that can be fitted within a tolerance range with respect to the depth w19 of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d.
- the length w18 of the insertion guide portion (drive) 343 is slightly shorter than the depth w19 of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d.
- the length w20 of the inserted guide portion (non-) 342 has a relationship that can be fitted within a tolerance range with respect to the depth w21 of the insertion guide portion (non-) 335d.
- the length w20 of the insertion guide portion (non) 342 is slightly shorter than the depth w21 of the insertion guide portion (non) 335d.
- the length w18 of the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 and the length w20 of the inserted guide portion (non) 342 are set to different lengths.
- the depth w19 of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d and the depth w21 of the insertion guide portion (non-) 335d are also set to different depths. This is to prevent the user from mistakenly mounting the driving side and the non-driving side of the toner cartridge E on the developing unit D when the user mounts the toner cartridge E on the developing unit D.
- the length w18 of the inserted guide portion (drive) 343 is set longer than the length w20 of the inserted guide portion (non-) 342. Accordingly, the depth w19 of the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d is set deeper than the depth w21 of the insertion guide portion (non-) 335d.
- the shapes of the inserted guide portion (drive) 343, the insertion guide portion (drive) 336d, the inserted guide portion (non) 342, and the insertion guide portion (non) 335d and the relationship among the elements were adjusted. Thereby, the mounting property of the toner cartridge E to the developing unit D can be improved.
- a toner cartridge E in which the configuration of the second shutter 253 and the like of the fourth embodiment is partially changed will be described. Since the configuration other than the toner cartridge E is substantially the same as that of the fourth embodiment, the description thereof is omitted.
- the configuration of the toner cartridge E may be omitted by using the same name for the same configuration as in the above embodiment.
- FIGS. 56 (a), (b), and (c) are explanatory views showing a state in which the second shutter is in the closed position.
- FIGS. 57A, 57B and 57C are explanatory views showing a state where the second shutter is in the open position.
- the third opening 249 can be opened and closed by moving the second shutter 553 relative to the container 547.
- a snap fit portion (support portion, connecting portion, elastic portion) 571 is connected to the shutter main body portion 553m. Further, a claw portion (first engagement portion, first projection portion) 571a is provided at the tip of the snap fit portion 571, and a projection portion (second engagement portion, second projection) is further provided on the claw portion 571a. Part) 571b is provided.
- the claw portion 571a and the projection portion 571b are engaging portions for engaging with the receiving device (developing unit D).
- the arm portion of the snap fit portion 571 is deformed when the engaging portions (the claw portion 571a and the protruding portion 571b) are in the retracted position. That is, as disclosed in FIGS. 56A, 56B, and 56C, when the second shutter 553 moves from the open position to the closed position, the regulated surface 571f of the snap-fit portion 571 becomes the regulating surface 547e. To touch. As a result, the snap fit portion 571 receives a force from the restricting surface 547e and deforms toward the outside in the axial direction. As a result, the engaging portions (the claw portions 571a and the protruding portions 571b) move to the retracted position.
- the engaging surface (the claw portion 571a and the projection portion 571b) is held at the retracted position by the contact between the regulating surface 571j (retracted position holding portion) and the snap fit portion 571.
- the container 547 may be provided with an engagement position moving part for moving the engagement part to the engagement position and an engagement position holding part for holding the engagement part at the engagement position (implementation). (See first restriction surface 247d of Example 4).
- the support portion (the arm portion of the snap fit portion 571) that supports the engaging portion has an elastic portion. That is, the engaging portions (the claw portions 571a and the protruding portions 571b) are moved to the engaging position by the elastic force of the support portion (snap fit portion 571) itself.
- the support itself does not need to have an elastic part.
- a support portion (support member, arm portion) that supports the engagement portion (claw portion 571a, projection portion 571b) is rotatably attached to the shutter main body portion 553m.
- a torsion spring elastic member, elastic portion
- the support portion is biased to the engagement position by the force of the torsion spring. If it is this structure, even if support part itself does not deform
- Example 4 a toner cartridge E in which the configuration of the second shutter 253 and the like of the fourth embodiment is partially changed will be described.
- the support part (arm part 271c) itself that supports the engaging part (claw part 271a, projection part 271b, etc.) of the second shutter was an elastic part.
- a present Example is an Example which provided the elastic member (elastic part) separately from the support part (support part). Moreover, a support part is supported so that a movement is possible.
- the configuration other than the toner cartridge E is substantially the same as that of the fourth embodiment, the description thereof is omitted. Further, the configuration of the toner cartridge E may be omitted by using the same name for the same configuration as in the above embodiments. Further, the drawings are simplified by omitting some shapes and parts. The dimensions, materials, shapes, and relative arrangements of the components described in the present embodiment should be changed as appropriate according to the configuration of the apparatus and various conditions. Therefore, the present invention is not intended to be limited to the configuration disclosed in the embodiments.
- FIG. 58 (a), (b), and (c) are explanatory views showing the second shutter of this embodiment.
- FIG. 59 is an explanatory view illustrating an engaging portion (engaging member) provided in the second shutter.
- FIGS. 60A and 60B and FIGS. 61A and 61B are explanatory views showing a state in which the second shutter is in the closed position.
- 62A, 62B, 63A, and 63B are explanatory views showing a state in which the second shutter is in the open position.
- the second opening (opening / closing member) 653 moves relative to the container 647 so that the third opening 249 can be opened and closed.
- the second shutter 653 includes a shutter main body (closed portion) 653m, an engagement member (support portion, support member) 671, an arm portion 672, a coil spring 675, and the like.
- the arm portion 672 is an arm portion extending from the lower end side to the distal end side of the shutter main body portion 653m, and an engagement member 671 and a coil spring (push spring) 675 are attached to the distal end side of the arm portion 672.
- the engagement member 671 has a claw portion (first engagement portion) 671a and a projection portion (second engagement portion) 671b.
- the claw portion 671a and the projection portion 671b are engagement portions (opening / closing member side engagement portions) provided in the second shutter 653, and have the same shape as the claw portion 271a and the projection portion 271b in the fourth embodiment.
- the claw portion 671a protrudes at least toward the outer side in the rotational radius direction of the second shutter 653. Further, the protrusion 671b protrudes at least downstream in the moving direction in which the second shutter 653 moves from the closed position to the open position.
- the portion excluding the engaging portions (claw portions 671a and 671b) from the engaging member 671 is a support portion that supports the engaging portion.
- the engaging member 671 is also a movable member (sliding member) that is slidable relative to the shutter main body 653m.
- a coil spring (elastic member, elastic portion) 675 is a biasing portion that biases the engaging member 671.
- the coil spring 675 is attached to a boss 671h provided on the engaging member 671, presses the surface (biased portion) 671e of the engaging member 671, and biases the engaging member 671 in a predetermined direction.
- the engaging member 671 (claw portion 671a, protrusion 671b) is urged toward the inner side in the axial direction by a coil spring (elastic member, elastic portion) 675.
- the engagement portions (claw portions 671a and 671b) are biased toward the engagement position by the coil spring 675.
- an elastic member (elastic portion) other than the coil spring may be used as the urging portion.
- a leaf spring may be used.
- the urging portion of this embodiment is a push spring, but if the arrangement of the urging portion with respect to the engaging member 671 is changed, a tension spring can be used as the urging portion. That is, it is possible to adopt a configuration in which the engaging portion is biased to the engaging position by using a force that pulls the engaging member 671 with the coil spring.
- the engaging member 671 when the second shutter 653 is in the closed position, the engaging member 671 is in contact with the regulating surface and moves. Is regulated. That is, the engaging portions (the claw portion 671a and the protruding portion 671b) are biased toward the engaging position by the coil spring 675, but are held at the retracted position by the restriction surface 647j provided on the container 647.
- the restricting surface 647j is a retracted position holding portion that holds the engaging portion in the retracted position against the coil spring 675.
- the container 647 is rotated in the direction of arrow e in FIG.
- the second shutter 653 rotates relative to the container 647 in the arrow h direction.
- the second shutter 653 is disposed at the open position, and the third opening (discharge port) is opened.
- the regulating surface 647j and the regulating surface 647e are separated from the engaging member 671 (the regulated surfaces 671f and 671k). Then, the engaging member 671 (the claw portion 671a and the protruding portion 671b) moves inward in the axial direction by the force of the coil spring 675 and moves to the engaging position. That is, the claw portion 671a is disposed at a position that can be engaged with the shutter holding portion 263, and the protrusion 671b is disposed at a position that can be engaged with the lock hole 263a.
- the coil spring 675 is an engaging position moving portion provided in the second shutter 653 to move the claw portion 671a and the protruding portion 671b to the engaging position.
- the container 647 rotates in the direction of arrow e shown in FIG. 63B from the state where the second shutter 653 is in the open position.
- the claw portion 671a at the engagement position engages with the shutter holding portion 263, and the protrusion 671b at the engagement position engages with the lock hole 263a.
- the movement of the second shutter 653 is restricted, and only the container 647 rotates in the direction of arrow e.
- the second shutter 653 rotates relative to the container 647 in the arrow h direction. That is, the second shutter 653 moves to the closed position using the force received by the claw portion 671a and the protrusion 671b from the shutter holding portion 263a.
- the regulating surface 647e provided on the container comes into contact with the regulated surface 671f provided on the engaging member 671 (claw portion 671a).
- the restricting surface 647e is a surface (inclined portion) that is inclined with respect to the moving direction (rotational direction) of the second shutter 653. Therefore, the engagement member 671 moves to the outside in the axial direction along the regulation surface 647e by contacting the regulation surface 647e. In other words, the engaging member 671 (the claw portion 671a and the protruding portion 671b) moves toward the retracted position against the elastic force of the coil spring 675 by the force received from the regulating surface 647e.
- the regulating surface 647e is a retreat position moving unit that moves the engaging portions (the claw portions 671a and the protrusions 671b) provided on the second shutter 653 toward the retreat position.
- the restricting surface 647e is a surface formed by convex portions (projections) provided on the container 647.
- a recess for example, a groove
- the regulating surface 647e may be provided by the recess.
- the engaging portion is moved toward the engaging position by the elastic portion (coil spring, elastic member) provided in the second shutter 653, and the engaging portion is engaged by the restriction surface (retracting position moving portion) provided in the container.
- the part is moved to the retracted position.
- the engaging portion is moved to the retracted position by an elastic member (coil spring or the like) provided on the second shutter 653, and the engaging portion is engaged by a regulating surface (engaging position moving portion) provided on the container.
- the structure moved to a joint position may be sufficient. That is, it is possible to adopt a configuration in which the elastic member (coil spring or the like) of the present embodiment is applied to the above-described embodiment 6.
- a toner cartridge that can be attached to and detached from an image forming apparatus or the like is provided.
- Second opening 43 Inserted guide portion 43a Abutting portion 43b Rotated guide portion 44 Gripping member 44a Fixing portion 44b Operation portion 53 Second shutter 53a Snap fit portion 53b Claw portion 53c End face 54 Second sealing seal 58 Communication Part 61 first lock arm 61a claw part 62 lock release claw 63 shutter holding part 64 stirring shaft seal
Landscapes
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Dry Development In Electrophotography (AREA)
- Electrophotography Configuration And Component (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Computer Vision & Pattern Recognition (AREA)
Abstract
Description
受け入れ装置に着脱可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と
を有し、
前記係合部は(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置へ回転することに伴って、前記係合部が前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする。
受け入れ装置に着脱可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と
を有し、
前記係合部は(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転することに伴って、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする。
回転動作を伴う装着動作により受け入れ装置に装着可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための開口部と、を有する容器と、
前記開口部を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記開口部を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記開口部を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記回転動作に伴って、前記係合部が前記退避位置から前記係合位置に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする。
回転動作を伴う取り外し動作により受け入れ装置から取り外し可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための開口部と、を有する容器と、
前記開口部を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記開口部を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記開口部を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記回転動作に伴って、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする。
受け入れ装置に着脱可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材であって、前記係合部は(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な開閉部材と、
前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ移動することに伴って、前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた退避位置移動部と、
を有することを特徴とする。
電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と、を有し、
前記開閉部材が前記閉位置と前記開位置の間を回転することに伴い、前記係合部が前記閉じ部に対して、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転軸線方向に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする。
電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と、を有し、
前記係合部は、前記開閉部材の回転半径方向の外側に少なくとも露出しており、
前記開閉部材が前記閉位置と前記開位置の間を回転することに伴って、前記係合部が前記閉じ部に対して少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転半径方向に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする。
電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と、を有し、
前記係合部は、
前記開閉部材の回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起と、
前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する方向の下流側に向けて突出している、前記第1の突起に設けられた第2の突起と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記閉位置と前記開位置の間を回転することに伴い、前記閉じ部に対して移動することを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。
電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材と、
前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に移動することに伴って、前記係合部を移動させる前記容器に設けられた移動部と、
を有することを特徴とする。
トナーカートリッジに用いられるシャッタにおいて、
実質的に円弧形状である本体部と、
前記本体部の長手方向における端部に設けられた第1のアーム部であって、前記本体部の短手方向における端部側に向けて延びる第1のアーム部と、
前記第1のアーム部の先端側に設けられて、前記円弧形状の径方向において外側に突出している第1の突起と、
を有し、
前記第1の突起が前記本体部に対して、少なくとも前記本体部の前記長手方向に移動可能であることを特徴とする。
§1.[電子写真画像形成装置の説明]
§2.[各カートリッジ(各ユニット)の構成について]
(現像ユニットのトナーカートリッジ受け入れ部近辺の詳細説明)
(トナーカートリッジの詳細説明)
容器枠体47aの第二トナー収容部47tの内部には、トナーを搬送するための第二トナー搬送部材46が回転可能に設けられている。なお、突起や穴等が互いに係合する位置を係合位置、係合が解除される位置を非係合位置(係合解除位置)と呼ぶ。
また、トナーカートリッジEは被回転ガイド部42bを備える。この被回転ガイド部42bは、トナーカートリッジEを回転させて第一シャッタ37と第二シャッタ53を開閉する際に、容器枠体47aをガイドする。容器47は被回転ガイド部42bによってスムーズに回転できる。被回転ガイド部42bはトナーカートリッジEの回転をガイドする回転ガイド(トナーカートリッジ側回転ガイド)である。被回転ガイド部42bは曲面形状(略円弧形状)を持つ。
§3.[トナーカートリッジの現像ユニットへの装着]
(トナーカートリッジの現像ユニットへの挿入動作)
(被挿入ガイド部の変形例について)
(トナーカートリッジの現像ユニットに対する位置決め)
§4.[シャッタの開閉動作について]
(シャッタの開放動作)
(トナーカートリッジの挿入動作からシャッタ開放動作への切り替わり)
M=F1×r1+F2×r2
M=F1×r1+F3×r3
(シャッタの閉塞動作)
つまり面47bは、第二シャッタ53が閉位置から開位置に移動する際(トナーカートリッジEが装着される際)には、爪部53bを退避位置から係合位置に案内する。逆に、第二シャッタ53が開位置から閉位置に移動する際(トナーカートリッジEが取り外される際)には、爪部53bを係合位置から退避位置に案内(ガイド)する。
(変形例)
(現像ユニット及びトナーカートリッジの概略説明)
(現像ユニット及びトナーカートリッジのシャッタ構成)
§2.[シャッタの開閉動作に関する説明]
(開放動作)
(閉塞動作)
§3.[シャッタを閉じる際のトナーこぼれ抑制構成について]
(トナー回収動作の説明)
aの第三開口部49の重力方向Gの下方に在る上流面(上流側端部)49aは、現像ユニットDの第二開口部30が重力方向下方になるように傾斜した面となっている。すなわち、上流面49aは、第三開口部49の端面において矢印u1方向(容器枠体47aの回転方向)に面した面領域であり、第一トナー収容部28(第二開口部30)側が第二トナー収容部47側よりも重力方向G下方に下るように傾斜している。
(その他)
§1.[現像ユニットのトナーカートリッジ受け入れ部近辺の詳細説明]
(カートリッジ、ユニットの概略構成について)
(トナーカートリッジの詳細説明)
ここで、第一、第二被規制面271d、271eは後述する容器247の第一規制面247d(図33(a))と当接する。また第三被規制面271fは、容器247の第二規制面247e(図33(a))と当接する。
§2.[トナーカートリッジの現像ユニットへの着脱におけるシャッタの開閉動作]
(第一ロックアームと第二ロックアームの動作)
(シャッタ保持部とトナーカートリッジのスナップフィット部の関係)
(第一シャッタと第二シャッタの動作)
(第二開口部と第三開口部とが連通するまでの動作)
§3.[現像ユニットからトナーカートリッジへの駆動伝達]
(現像ユニットからトナーカートリッジへの駆動伝達構成)
(トナーカートリッジから現像ユニットへのトナーの搬送)
(シャッタの閉塞動作)
§1.[ガイド部について]
(被挿入ガイド部(駆)と挿入ガイド部(駆)の関係)
(被挿入ガイド部(非)と挿入ガイド部(非)の関係)
§2.[トナーカートリッジ端部のガイド形状について]
(被挿入ガイド部(駆)343と被挿入ガイド部(非)342の関係について)
43 被挿入ガイド部
43a 突き当て部
43b 被回転ガイド部
44 把持部材
44a 固定部
44b 操作部
53 第二シャッタ
53a スナップフィット部
53b 爪部
53c 先端面
54 第二封止シール
58 連通部
61 第一ロックアーム
61a 爪部
62 ロック解除爪
63 シャッタ保持部
64 撹拌軸シール
Claims (497)
- 受け入れ装置に着脱可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と
を有し、
前記係合部は(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置へ回転することに伴って、前記係合部が前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置へ回転することによって、前記係合部が前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項1に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転することに伴って前記係合部を前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた係合位置移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項1または2に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記係合位置へ向けて付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項3に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項3または4に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項3または4に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記係合位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた係合位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至6のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転することに伴って、前記係合部を前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至7のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項8に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項8に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項8乃至10のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転することに伴い、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項1乃至11のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転することによって、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項12に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴い、前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた退避位置移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項12または13に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記退避位置へ向けて付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項14に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項14または15に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項14または15に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記退避位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた退避位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至17のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴って、前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させるための第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至18のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項19に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記第2の弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項19に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記第2の弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項19乃至21のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転軸線方向に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項1乃至22のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記回転軸線方向における内側に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項23に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転半径方向に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項1乃至24のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転半径方向外側に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項25に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材の回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至26のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する方向において下流側に少なくとも突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項27に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起は、前記第1の突起に設けられていることを特徴とする請求項28に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項28または29に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至30のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項31に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項31または32のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項31乃至33のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項1乃至34のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至35のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項36に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項37に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除力受け部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って、前記受け入れ装置から力を受けることを特徴とする請求項38に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項36乃至39のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い前記受入口を閉めさせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える閉塞力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至40のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に係合し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項41に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴と係合するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項41または42に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記閉塞力付与部が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合し得るように、前記トナーカートリッジの姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項41乃至43のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材は、前記受入口を閉める位置にロックされており、
前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合することに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材のロックを解除することを特徴とする請求項41乃至44のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置にある際に前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する回転方向において、前記排出口よりも下流側であってかつ前記閉塞力付与部よりも上流側に配置されることを特徴とする請求項41乃至45のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に前記受入口を開かせることを特徴とする請求項41乃至46のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受入口を開かせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える開放力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至47のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開放力付与部は、前記容器に設けられた段差部であることを特徴とする請求項48に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、
前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、
前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、
前記受入口を閉じた位置に前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックする受け入れ装置側ロック部材と、
を有し、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材のロックを解除するためのロック解除部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至49のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材と接触し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項50に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴に進入するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項50または51に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の挿入姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記ロック解除部が前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材に接触するように、前記トナーカートリッジの挿入姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項50乃至52のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックするのを許容することを特徴とする請求項50乃至53のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記開閉部材を前記閉位置から前記開位置へと動かす力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って受け得る開放力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至54のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジは、回転動作を伴う装着動作によって前記受け入れ装置に装着されることを特徴とする請求項1乃至55のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記回転動作に伴って前記開位置から前記閉位置へと回転することを特徴とする請求項56に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジは、前記受け入れ装置に略直線的に挿入されたのち前記回転動作を行うことによって前記受け入れ装置に装着されることを特徴とする請求項56または57に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置に対する前記トナーカートリッジの装着をガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至58のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の回転をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至59のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至60のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項61に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転方向は、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する回転方向と同じ向きであることを特徴とする請求項62に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転軸線と、前記開閉部材の回転軸線は異なる位置に配置されていることを特徴とする請求項63に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、実質的に円弧形状である円弧部を有し、
前記円弧部に前記排出口が設けられ、前記円弧部に沿って前記開閉部材は回転することを特徴とする請求項1乃至64のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記容器は実質的に円筒形状である円筒部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至65のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記円筒部の曲面に沿って前記開閉部材が回転することを特徴とする請求項66に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器の長手方向端部における径が、前記容器の前記排出口近傍における径よりも大きいことを特徴とする請求項66または67に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉じ部は、実質的に円弧形状であることを特徴とする請求項1乃至68のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項1乃至69のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを所定の挿入方向にガイドする、前記容器に設けられたガイド部を有し、
前記開閉部材の回転軸線と垂直な投影面に前記トナーカートリッジを投影した際、前記回転軸線を通り前記挿入方向に平行な仮想線で前記トナーカートリッジを2つの領域に分割すると、前記把持部は、前記排出口と同じ領域に位置することを特徴とする請求項70に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 受け入れ装置に着脱可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と
を有し、
前記係合部は(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転することに伴って、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転することによって、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項72に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴って前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた退避位置移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項72または73に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記退避位置へ向けて付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項74に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項74または75に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項74または75に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記退避位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた退避位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至77のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴って、前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至78のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項79に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項79に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項79乃至81のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転軸線方向に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項72乃至82のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記回転軸線方向における外側に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項83に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転半径方向に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項72乃至84のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転半径方向内側に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項85に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材の回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至86のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する方向において下流側に少なくとも突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項87に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起は、前記第1の突起に設けられていることを特徴とする請求項88に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項88または89に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至90のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項91に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項91または92のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項91乃至93のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項72乃至94のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記係合位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた係合位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至95のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至96のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項97に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項98に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除力受け部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って、前記受け入れ装置から力を受けることを特徴とする請求項99に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項97乃至100のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い前記受入口を閉めさせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える閉塞力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至101のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に係合し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項102に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴と係合するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項102または103に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記閉塞力付与部が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合し得るように、前記トナーカートリッジの姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項102乃至104のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材は、前記受入口を閉める位置にロックされており、
前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合することに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材のロックを解除することを特徴とする請求項102乃至105のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置にある際に前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する回転方向において、前記排出口よりも下流側であってかつ前記閉塞力付与部よりも上流側に配置されることを特徴とする請求項102乃至106のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に前記受入口を開かせることを特徴とする請求項102乃至107のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受入口を開かせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える開放力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至108のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開放力付与部は、前記容器に設けられた段差部であることを特徴とする請求項109に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、
前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、
前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、
前記受入口を閉じた位置に前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックする受け入れ装置側ロック部材と、
を有し、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材のロックを解除するためのロック解除部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至110のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材と接触し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項111に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴に進入するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項111または112に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の挿入姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記ロック解除部が前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材に接触するように、前記トナーカートリッジの挿入姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項111乃至113のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックするのを許容することを特徴とする請求項111乃至114のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記開閉部材を前記閉位置から前記開位置へと動かす力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って受け得る開放力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至115のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジは、回転動作を伴う取り外し動作によって前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることを特徴とする請求項72乃至116のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記回転動作に伴って前記開位置から前記閉位置へと回転することを特徴とする請求項117に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジは、前記回転動作を行った後、前記受け入れ装置から略直線的に抜き出されることによって前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることを特徴とする請求項117または118に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置に対する前記トナーカートリッジの取り外しをガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至119のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の回転をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至120のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至121のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項122に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転方向は、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する回転方向と同じ向きであることを特徴とする請求項123に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転軸線と、前記開閉部材の回転軸線は異なる位置に配置されていることを特徴とする請求項123または124に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、実質的に円弧形状である円弧部を有し、
前記円弧部に前記排出口が設けられ、前記円弧部に沿って前記開閉部材は回転することを特徴とする請求項72乃至125のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記容器は実質的に円筒形状である円筒部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至126のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記円筒部の曲面に沿って前記開閉部材が回転することを特徴とする請求項127に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器の長手方向端部における径が、前記容器の前記排出口近傍における径よりも大きいことを特徴とする請求項127または128に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉じ部は、実質的に円弧形状であることを特徴とする請求項72乃至129のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項72乃至130のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを所定の挿入方向にガイドする、前記容器に設けられたガイド部を有し、
前記開閉部材の回転軸線と垂直な投影面に前記トナーカートリッジを投影した際、前記回転軸線を通り前記挿入方向に平行な仮想線で前記トナーカートリッジを2つの領域に分割すると、前記把持部は、前記排出口と同じ領域に位置することを特徴とする請求項131に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 回転動作を伴う装着動作により受け入れ装置に装着可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記回転動作に伴って、前記係合部が前記退避位置から前記係合位置に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記回転動作によって、前記係合部が前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項133に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転動作に伴って前記係合部を前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた係合位置移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項133または134に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記係合位置へ向けて付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項135に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項135または136に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項135または136に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記係合位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた係合位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至138のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転動作に伴って前記係合部を前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至139のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項140に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項140に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項140乃至142のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジは、回転動作を伴う取り外し動作によって前記受け入れ装置から取り外されるものであって、
前記取り外し動作における前記回転動作に伴い、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項133乃至143のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記取り外し動作における前記回転動作によって、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項144に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記取り外し動作における前記回転動作に伴い前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた退避位置移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項144または145に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記退避位置へ向けて付勢する付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項146に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項146または147に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項146または147に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記退避位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた退避位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至149のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記取り外し動作における前記回転動作に伴って前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させるための第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至150のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項151に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記第2の弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢する弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項152に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記第2の弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項151乃至153のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記トナーカートリッジの回転軸線方向に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項133乃至154のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記回転軸線方向における内側に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項155に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記トナーカートリッジの回転半径方向に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項133乃至156のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記トナーカートリッジの回転半径方向外側に移動することによって前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項157に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記トナーカートリッジの回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至158のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記装着動作における前記トナーカートリッジの回転方向において上流側に少なくとも突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項159に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起は、前記第1の突起に設けられることを特徴とする請求項160に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項160または161に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項132乃至162のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項163に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項163または164に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項163乃至165のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項133乃至166のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至167のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項168に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項169に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除力受け部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受け入れ装置から力を受けることを特徴とする請求項170に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項166乃至171のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い前記受入口を閉めさせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える閉塞力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至172のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に係合し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項173に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴と係合するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項173または174に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記閉塞力付与部が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合し得るように、前記トナーカートリッジの姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項173乃至175のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材は、前記受入口を閉める位置にロックされており、
前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合することに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材のロックを解除することを特徴とする請求項173乃至176のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置にある際に前記係合部は、前記装着動作における前記トナーカートリッジの回転方向において、前記排出口よりも下流側であってかつ前記閉塞力付与部よりも上流側に配置されることを特徴とする請求項173乃至177のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に前記受入口を開かせることを特徴とする請求項173乃至178のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受入口を開かせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える開放力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至179のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開放力付与部は、前記容器に設けられた段差部であることを特徴とする請求項180に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、
前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、
前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、
前記受入口を閉じた位置に前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックする受け入れ装置側ロック部材と、
を有し、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材のロックを解除するためのロック解除部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至181のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材と接触し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項182に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴に進入するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項182または183に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の挿入姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記ロック解除部が前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材に接触するように、前記トナーカートリッジの挿入姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項182乃至184のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックするのを許容することを特徴とする請求項182乃至185のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記開閉部材を前記閉位置から前記開位置へと動かす力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って受け得る開放力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至186のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジは、前記受け入れ装置に略直線的に挿入されたのち前記回転動作を行うことによって前記受け入れ装置に装着されることを特徴とする請求項133乃至187のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置に対する前記トナーカートリッジの装着をガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至188のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の移動をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至189のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至190のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項191に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転方向は、前記装着動作における前記トナーカートリッジの回転方向と同じ向きであることを特徴とする請求項192に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転軸線と、前記トナーカートリッジの回転軸線は異なる位置に配置されていることを特徴とする請求項192または193に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器に対して回転し得ることを特徴とする請求項133乃至194のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、実質的に円弧形状である円弧部を有し、
前記円弧部に前記排出口が設けられ、前記円弧部に沿って前記開閉部材は回転することを特徴とする請求項133乃至195のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記容器は実質的に円筒形状である円筒部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至195のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記円筒部の曲面に沿って前記開閉部材が回転することを特徴とする請求項197に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器の長手方向端部における径が、前記容器の前記排出口近傍における径よりも大きいことを特徴とする請求項133乃至198のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉じ部は、実質的に円弧形状であることを特徴とする請求項133乃至199のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項133乃至200のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを所定の挿入方向にガイドする、前記容器に設けられたガイド部を有し、
前記トナーカートリッジの回転軸線と垂直な投影面に前記トナーカートリッジを投影した際、前記回転軸線を通り前記挿入方向に平行な仮想線で前記トナーカートリッジを2つの領域に分割すると、前記把持部は、前記排出口と同じ領域に位置することを特徴とする請求項201に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 回転動作を伴う取り外し動作により受け入れ装置から取り外し可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有する開閉部材であって、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能であり、
前記回転動作に伴って、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記回転動作によって、前記係合部が前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項203に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転動作に伴い前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた退避位置移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項203または204に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記退避位置へ向けて付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項205に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項205または206に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項205または206に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記退避位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた退避位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至208のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転動作に伴って前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至209のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項210に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項210に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項210乃至212のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記トナーカートリッジの回転軸線方向に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項203乃至213のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記回転軸線方向における外側に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項214に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記トナーカートリッジの回転半径方向に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項203乃至215のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記トナーカートリッジの回転半径方向内側に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項216に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記トナーカートリッジの回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至217のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記取り外し動作における前記トナーカートリッジの回転方向において下流側に少なくとも突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項218に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起は、前記第1の突起に設けられることを特徴とする請求項219に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項219または220に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至221のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項222に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部が前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項222または223に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部が前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項222乃至224のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項203乃至225のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記係合位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた係合位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至226のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至227のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項228に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項229に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除力受け部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って、前記受け入れ装置から力を受けることを特徴とする請求項230に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項228乃至231のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い前記受入口を閉めさせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える閉塞力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至232のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に係合し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項233に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴と係合するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項233または234に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記閉塞力付与部が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合し得るように、前記トナーカートリッジの姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項233乃至235のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材は、前記受入口を閉める位置にロックされており、
前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合することに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材のロックを解除することを特徴とする請求項233乃至236のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置にある際に前記係合部は、前記取り外し動作における前記トナーカートリッジの回転方向において、前記排出口よりも上流側であってかつ前記閉塞力付与部よりも下流側に配置されることを特徴とする請求項233乃至237のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に前記受入口を開かせることを特徴とする請求項233乃至238のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受入口を開かせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える開放力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至239のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開放力付与部は、前記容器に設けられた段差部であることを特徴とする請求項240に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、
前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、
前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、
前記受入口を閉じた位置に前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックする受け入れ装置側ロック部材と、
を有し、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材のロックを解除するためのロック解除部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至240のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材と接触し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項242に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴に進入するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項242または243に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の挿入姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記ロック解除部が前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材に接触するように、前記トナーカートリッジの挿入姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項242乃至244のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックするのを許容することを特徴とする請求項242乃至245のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記開閉部材を前記閉位置から前記開位置へと動かす力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴い受け得る開放力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至246のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジは、前記回転動作を行った後、前記受け入れ装置から略直線的に抜き出されることで前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることを特徴とする請求項203乃至247のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置に対する前記トナーカートリッジの装着をガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至247のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の移動をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至249のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至250のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項251に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転方向は、前記取り外し動作における前記トナーカートリッジの回転方向と反対の向きであることを特徴とする請求項252に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転軸線と、前記トナーカートリッジの回転軸線は異なる位置に配置されていることを特徴とする請求項252または253に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器に対して回転し得ることを特徴とする請求項203乃至254のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、実質的に円弧形状である円弧部を有し、
前記円弧部に前記排出口が設けられ、前記円弧部に沿って前記開閉部材は回転することを特徴とする請求項203乃至255のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記容器は実質的に円筒形状である円筒部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至256のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記円筒部の曲面に沿って前記開閉部材が回転することを特徴とする請求項203乃至257のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器の長手方向端部における径が、前記容器の前記排出口近傍における径よりも大きいことを特徴とする請求項203乃至258のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉じ部は、実質的に円弧形状であることを特徴とする請求項203乃至259のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項203乃至260のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを所定の挿入方向にガイドする、前記容器に設けられたガイド部を有し、
前記トナーカートリッジの回転軸線と垂直な投影面に前記トナーカートリッジを投影した際、前記回転軸線を通り前記挿入方向に平行な仮想線で前記トナーカートリッジを2つの領域に分割すると、前記把持部は、前記排出口と同じ領域に位置することを特徴とする請求項261に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 受け入れ装置に着脱可能なトナーカートリッジであって、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部から前記受け入れ装置へトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、(a)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせる開位置と、(b)前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉めさせる閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材であって、前記係合部は(c)前記開閉部材を前記開位置から前記閉位置に動かすための力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外される際に受けるべく前記受け入れ装置に係合するための係合位置と、(d)前記係合位置から退避した退避位置と、の間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な開閉部材と、
前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ移動することに伴って、前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた退避位置移動部と、
を有することを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記退避位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記退避位置へ向けて付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項263に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項263または264に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項263または264に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記退避位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた退避位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至266のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に移動することに伴って前記係合部を前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至267のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項268に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項268に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項268乃至270のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴い、前記係合部を前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動させる、前記容器に設けられた係合位置移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至271のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記退避位置移動部は、前記係合部を前記係合位置へ向けて付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項272に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項272または273に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合位置移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項272または273に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記係合位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた係合位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至275のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転することに伴って、前記係合部を前記退避位置から前記係合位置へ移動させるための第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至276のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項277に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記第2の弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項277に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記第2の弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項277乃至279のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記閉じ部の長手方向に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項263乃至280のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、少なくとも前記長手方向における外側に移動することによって前記係合位置から前記退避位置へ移動することを特徴とする請求項281に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至282のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記第1の突起に設けられて、前記第1の突起とは異なる向きに突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項283のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項284に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至285のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項286に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部はスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項286または287に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は前記退避位置と前記係合位置の間を移動することを特徴とする請求項286乃至288のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項263乃至289のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部を前記係合位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた係合位置保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至290のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至291のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項292に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項293に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除力受け部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴い、前記受け入れ装置から力を受けることを特徴とする請求項294に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項292乃至295のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い前記受入口を閉めさせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える閉塞力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至296のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に係合し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項296に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴と係合するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項297または298に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記閉塞力付与部が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合し得るように、前記トナーカートリッジの姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項297乃至299のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材は、前記受入口を閉める位置にロックされており、
前記閉塞力付与部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材と係合することに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材のロックを解除することを特徴とする請求項297乃至300のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記閉塞力付与部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に前記受入口を開かせることを特徴とする請求項297乃至301のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、を有するものであって、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴って前記受入口を開かせるべく前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に力を加える開放力付与部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至302のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開放力付与部は、前記容器に設けられた段差部であることを特徴とする請求項303に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置は、
前記排出口から排出されたトナーを受け入れる受入口と、
前記受入口を開閉する受け入れ装置側開閉部材と、
前記受入口を閉じた位置に前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックする受け入れ装置側ロック部材と、
を有し、
前記トナーカートリッジは、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材のロックを解除するためのロック解除部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至304のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材と接触し得る突起であることを特徴とする請求項305に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック解除部は、前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材に設けられた穴に進入するように構成されることを特徴とする請求項305または306に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に挿入される際の挿入姿勢を規制するための姿勢規制部を有し、
前記姿勢規制部は、前記ロック解除部が前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材に接触するように、前記トナーカートリッジの挿入姿勢を規制することを特徴とする請求項305乃至307のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記ロック解除部は、前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置から取り外されることに伴い、前記受け入れ装置側ロック部材が前記受け入れ装置側開閉部材をロックするのを許容することを特徴とする請求項305乃至308のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記開閉部材を前記閉位置から前記開位置へと動かす力を前記トナーカートリッジが前記受け入れ装置に装着されることに伴い受け得る開放力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至309のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記受け入れ装置に対する前記トナーカートリッジの装着をガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至310のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の移動をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至311のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至312のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項313に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項263乃至314のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 請求項1乃至314のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジと、
前記トナーカートリッジを装着するための装着部を有する前記受け入れ装置と、
を有することを特徴とするトナー供給機構。 - 電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と、
を有し、
前記開閉部材が前記閉位置と前記開位置の間を回転することに伴い、前記係合部が前記閉じ部に対して、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転軸線方向に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置と前記開位置の間を回転することによって、前記係合部が前記閉じ部に対して、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転軸線方向に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項317に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴い、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転軸線方向における外側に移動することを特徴とする請求項318に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転することに伴い、少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転軸線方向における内側に移動することを特徴とする請求項318または319に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が回転することに伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記軸線方向外側に移動させる、前記容器に設けられた第1の移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至320のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記軸線方向に移動させる、前記容器に設けられた第1の移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至321のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第1の移動部は、前記係合部を前記軸線方向に付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項321または322に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第1の移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項321乃至323のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第1の移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項321乃至323のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が回転することに伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記軸線方向外側に移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至325のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項326に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項326に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項326乃至328のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が回転することに伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記軸線方向内側に移動させる、前記容器に設けられた第2の移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至329のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転することに伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記軸線方向に移動させる、前記容器に設けられた第2の移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至330のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記係合部を前記軸線方向に付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項330または331に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項330乃至332のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項330乃至333のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が回転することに伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記軸線方向内側に移動させるための第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至334のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項335に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記第2の弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項335に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記第2の弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項335乃至337のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転することに伴い第1の位置から第2の位置へ移動し、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴い前記第2の位置から前記第1の位置へ向けて移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項317乃至338のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置に位置する際に前記係合部の位置を前記第1の位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた第1の保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項339に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部の位置を第2の位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた第2の保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項339または340に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材の回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至341のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する方向において下流側に少なくとも突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項342に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起は、前記第1の突起に設けられることを特徴とする請求項343に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項344に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至345のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項346に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項346または347に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項346乃至348のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項317乃至349のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転するための力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得るように構成されていることを特徴とする請求項317乃至350のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至351のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項352に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項353に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項352乃至354のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器に設けられて、略同じ方向に突出している2つの容器側突起部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至355のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記2つの容器側突起部と前記排出口を前記開閉部材の回転軸線に投影すると、
前記2つの容器側突起部に挟まれた領域のなかに前記排出口が含まれることを特徴とする請求項356に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置にある際に前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する回転方向において、前記排出口よりも下流側であってかつ前記2つの容器側突起部よりも上流側に配置されることを特徴とする請求項356または357に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジをガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至358のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の回転をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至359のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至360のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項361に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転軸線と、前記開閉部材の回転軸線は異なる位置に配置されていることを特徴とする請求項361または362に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、実質的に円弧形状である円弧部を有し、
前記円弧部に前記排出口が設けられ、前記円弧部に沿って前記開閉部材は回転することを特徴とする請求項317乃至363のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記容器は実質的に円筒形状である円筒部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至364のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記円筒部の曲面に沿って前記開閉部材が回転することを特徴とする請求項365に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器の長手方向端部における径が、前記容器の前記排出口近傍における径よりも大きいことを特徴とする請求項317乃至366のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉じ部は、実質的に円弧形状であることを特徴とする請求項317乃至367のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項317乃至368のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 所定の方向に沿って設けられたガイド部を有し、
前記開閉部材の回転軸線と垂直な投影面に前記トナーカートリッジを投影した際、前記回転軸線を通り前記所定の方向に平行な仮想線で前記トナーカートリッジを2つの領域に分割すると、前記把持部は、前記排出口と同じ領域に位置することを特徴とする請求項369に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、前記開閉部材の回転半径方向の外側に少なくとも露出しており、
前記開閉部材が前記閉位置と前記開位置の間を回転することに伴って、前記係合部が前記閉じ部に対して少なくとも前記開閉部材の回転半径方向に移動するように構成されたことを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する際に、少なくとも前記回転半径方向における外側に移動することを特徴とする請求項371に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する際に、少なくとも前記回転半径方向における内側に移動することを特徴とする請求項371または372に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に移動することに伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記回転半径方向に移動させる、前記容器に設けられた移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至373のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材の回転に伴い、前記係合部を少なくとも前記回転半径方向の外側に移動させる移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項374に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記移動部は、前記係合部を前記回転半径方向に付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項374または375に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が回転することに伴って前記係合部を少なくとも前記回転半径方向に移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至376のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記弾性部は、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に移動することに伴い前記係合部を移動させることを特徴とする請求項377に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記弾性部は、前記係合部を少なくとも前記回転半径方向内側に移動させることを特徴とする請求項377または378に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項377乃至379のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項377乃至379のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項377乃至381のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転することに伴い第1の位置から第2の位置へ移動し、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転することに伴い前記第2の位置から前記第1の位置へ向けて移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項371乃至382のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部の位置を前記第2の位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項383に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材の回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至384のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部が、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する方向において下流側に少なくとも突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項385のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起は、前記第1の突起に設けられていることを特徴とする請求項386に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項387に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至388のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項389に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項389または390に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項389乃至391のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項389乃至392のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転するための力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得るように構成されていることを特徴とする請求項371乃至393のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至394のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項395に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項395に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項395乃至397のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器に設けられて、略同じ方向に突出している2つの容器側突起部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至398のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記2つの容器側突起部と前記排出口を前記開閉部材の回転軸線に投影すると、
前記2つの容器側突起部に挟まれた領域のなかに前記排出口が含まれることを特徴とする請求項399に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置にある際に前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する回転方向において、前記排出口よりも下流側であってかつ前記2つの容器側突起部よりも上流側に配置されることを特徴とする請求項400に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジをガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至401のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の回転をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至402のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至403のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項404に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転軸線と、前記開閉部材の回転軸線は異なる位置に配置されていることを特徴とする請求項404または405に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、実質的に円弧形状である円弧部を有し、
前記円弧部に前記排出口が設けられ、前記円弧部に沿って前記開閉部材は回転することを特徴とする請求項371乃至406のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記容器は実質的に円筒形状である円筒部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至407のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記円筒部の曲面に沿って前記開閉部材が回転することを特徴とする請求項408に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器の長手方向端部における径が、前記容器の前記排出口近傍における径よりも大きいことを特徴とする請求項371乃至409のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉じ部は、実質的に円弧形状であることを特徴とする請求項371乃至410のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項371乃至411のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 所定の方向に沿って設けられたガイド部を有し、
前記開閉部材の回転軸線と垂直な投影面に前記トナーカートリッジを投影した際、
前記回転軸線を通り前記所定の方向に平行な仮想線で前記トナーカートリッジを2つの領域に分割すると、前記把持部は、前記排出口と同じ領域に位置することを特徴とする請求項412に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して回転し得る開閉部材と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、
前記開閉部材の回転半径方向外側に少なくとも突出している第1の突起と、
前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する方向の下流側に向けて突出している、前記第1の突起に設けられた第2の突起と、
を有し、
前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記閉位置と前記開位置の間を回転することに伴い、前記閉じ部に対して移動することを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記第2の突起は、前記第1の突起の先端側に設けられていることを特徴とする請求項414に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項414または415に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する際に、前記係合部を移動させる前記容器に設けられた第1の移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至416のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に回転する際に、前記係合部を移動させる前記容器に設けられた第2の移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至416のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至418のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項419に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項419または420に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項419乃至421のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項414乃至422のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ回転するための力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得るように構成されていることを特徴とする請求項414乃至423のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至423のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項425に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項426に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項425乃至427のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器に設けられて、略同じ方向に突出している2つの容器側突起部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至428のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記2つの容器側突起部と前記排出口を前記開閉部材の回転軸線に投影すると、
前記2つの容器側突起部に挟まれた領域のなかに前記排出口が含まれることを特徴とする請求項429に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置にある際に前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記容器に対して前記開位置から前記閉位置に回転する回転方向において、前記排出口よりも下流側であってかつ前記2つの容器側突起部よりも上流側に配置されることを特徴とする請求項429または430に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジをガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至431のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の移動をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至432のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至433のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項434に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記回転力受け部の回転軸線と、前記開閉部材の回転軸線は異なる位置に配置されていることを特徴とする請求項434または435に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、実質的に円弧形状である円弧部を有し、
前記円弧部に前記排出口が設けられ、前記円弧部に沿って前記開閉部材は回転することを特徴とする請求項414乃至436のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記容器は実質的に円筒形状である円筒部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至437のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記円筒部の曲面に沿って前記開閉部材が回転することを特徴とする請求項438のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器の長手方向端部における径が、前記容器の前記排出口近傍における径よりも大きいことを特徴とする請求項414乃至439のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記閉じ部は、実質的に円弧形状であることを特徴とする請求項414乃至440のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項414乃至441のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 所定の方向に沿って設けられたガイド部を有し、
前記開閉部材の回転軸線と垂直な投影面に前記トナーカートリッジを投影した際、前記回転軸線を通り前記所定の方向に平行な仮想線で前記トナーカートリッジを2つの領域に分割すると、前記把持部は、前記排出口と同じ領域に位置することを特徴とする請求項442に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 電子写真画像形成用のトナーカートリッジにおいて、
トナーを収容するための収容部と、前記収容部からトナーを排出するための排出口と、を有する容器と、
前記排出口を閉じるための閉じ部と、前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な係合部と、を有し、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を開かせるための開位置と、前記閉じ部に前記排出口を閉じさせるための閉位置と、の間を前記容器に対して移動し得る開閉部材と、
前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に移動することに伴って、前記係合部を移動させる前記容器に設けられた移動部と、
を有することを特徴とするトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記移動部は、前記係合部を付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項444に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記移動部は、前記係合部を少なくとも前記閉じ部の長手方向に移動させることを特徴とする請求項444または445に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記移動部は、前記係合部を少なくとも前記閉じ部の長手方向における外側に移動させることを特徴とする請求項446に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項444乃至447のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項444乃至447のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に移動することに伴い、前記係合部を移動させるための弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至449のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項450に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項450に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項450乃至452のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に移動することに伴い、前記係合部を移動させる、前記容器に設けられた第2の移動部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至453のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記係合部を付勢するための付勢部を有することを特徴とする請求項454に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記係合部を少なくとも前記閉じ部の長手方向に移動させることを特徴とする請求項454または455に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記係合部を少なくとも前記閉じ部の長手方向における内側に移動させることを特徴とする請求項456に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凸部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項454乃至457のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の移動部は、前記容器に設けられた凹部によって形成されていることを特徴とする請求項454乃至457のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に移動することに伴い、前記係合部を移動させるための第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至459のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持する支持部を有し、
前記支持部が前記第2の弾性部を有することを特徴とする請求項460に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記開閉部材は、前記係合部を支持し前記閉じ部に対して移動可能な支持部を有し、
前記第2の弾性部は、前記支持部を付勢するための弾性部材であることを特徴とする請求項460に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記第2の弾性部は金属製であることを特徴とする請求項460乃至462のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記閉位置から前記開位置に移動することに伴い第1の位置から第2の位置へ移動し、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置に移動することに伴い前記第2の位置から前記第1の位置へ向けて移動するように構成されたことを特徴とする請求項444乃至463のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記閉位置に位置する際に前記係合部の位置を第1の位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた第1の保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項464に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材が前記開位置に位置する際に前記係合部の位置を第2の位置に保持する、前記容器に設けられた第2の保持部を有することを特徴とする請求項464または465に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、第1の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至466のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記係合部は、前記第1の突起に設けられて、前記第1の突起とは異なる向きに突出している第2の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項467に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さに比べて低いことを特徴とする請求項468に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は前記係合部を支持する支持部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至469のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が変形することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項470に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部がスライド移動することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項470または471に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記支持部が回転することによって、前記係合部は移動することを特徴とする請求項470乃至472のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記閉じ部の先端側に向けて延びるアーム部を有し、
前記アーム部の先端側に前記係合部が設けられていることを特徴とする請求項444乃至473のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。 - 前記係合部は、前記開閉部材が前記開位置から前記閉位置へ移動するための力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得るように構成されていることを特徴とする請求項444乃至474のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記容器と係合して前記開閉部材を前記閉位置にロックするロック部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至475のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部は、前記開閉部材をロックするロック位置と、前記ロックを解除するロック解除位置との間を前記閉じ部に対して移動可能である請求項476に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記開閉部材は、前記ロック部を前記ロック位置から前記ロック解除位置へ動かすための力を受けるロック解除力受け部を有する請求項477に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記ロック部を覆うカバー部を有することを特徴とする請求項476乃至478のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器に設けられて、略同じ方向に突出している2つの容器側突起部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至479のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジをガイドするためのガイド部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至480のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記容器は、前記開閉部材の移動をガイドする開閉ガイドを有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至481のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記収容部のトナーを前記排出口に向けて搬送するための搬送部材を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至482のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記搬送部材を駆動させるための回転力を前記トナーカートリッジの外部から受け得る回転力受け部を有することを特徴とする請求項483に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- 前記トナーカートリッジを把持するための把持部を有することを特徴とする請求項444乃至484のいずれか1項に記載のトナーカートリッジ。
- トナーカートリッジに用いられるシャッタにおいて、
実質的に円弧形状である本体部と、
前記本体部の長手方向端部に設けられた第1のアーム部であって、前記本体部の短手方向における端部側に向けて延びる第1のアーム部と、
前記第1のアーム部の先端側に設けられて、前記円弧形状の径方向において外側に突出している第1の突起と、
を有し、
前記第1の突起が前記本体部に対して、少なくとも前記本体部の前記長手方向に移動可能であることを特徴とするシャッタ。 - 前記第1の突起に設けられて、前記第1のアーム部の後端側に向けて突出している第2の突起と、
を有することを特徴とする請求項486に記載のシャッタ。 - 前記第2の突起の高さは、前記第1の突起の高さより低いことを特徴とする請求項487に記載のシャッタ。
- 前記本体部の長手方向において、前記第1のアーム部が設けられた側とは反対側の端部に設けられた第2のアーム部であって、前記本体部の短手方向における前記端部側に向けて延びる第2のアーム部と、
前記第2のアーム部の先端側に設けられて前記略円弧形状の径方向において外側に突出している第3の突起と、
を有し、
前記第3の突起が前記本体部に対して、少なくとも前記本体部の長手方向に移動可能であることを特徴とする請求項486乃至488のいずれか1項に記載のシャッタ。 - 前記第3の突起に設けられて、前記第2のアーム部の後端側に向けて突出している第4の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項489に記載のシャッタ。
- 前記第4の突起の高さは、前記第3の突起の高さより低いことを特徴とする請求項490に記載のシャッタ。
- 前記第1のアーム部と前記本体部の間に配置されて、前記本体部の短手方向における前記端部側に向けて延びる第3のアーム部を有し、
前記第3のアーム部は、前記第1のアーム部に近づく向きに突出している第5の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項486乃至491のいずれか1項に記載のシャッタ。 - 前記第5の突起は、前記本体部に対して少なくとも前記本体部の前記長手方向に移動可能であることを特徴とする請求項492に記載のシャッタ。
- 前記第3のアーム部は、前記第3のアーム部の先端側に近づくにつれて前記本体部に近づく向きに傾斜している傾斜部を有することを特徴とする請求項493に記載のシャッタ。
- 前記第2のアーム部と前記本体部の間に配置されて、前記本体部の短手方向における前記端部側に向けて延びる第4のアーム部を有し、
前記第4のアーム部は、前記第2のアーム部に近づく向きに突出している第6の突起を有することを特徴とする請求項489乃至491のいずれか1項に記載のシャッタ。 - 前記第6の突起は、前記本体部に対して少なくとも前記本体部の長手方向に移動可能であることを特徴とする請求項495に記載のシャッタ。
- 前記第4のアーム部は、前記第4のアーム部の先端側に近づくにつれて前記本体部に近づく向きに傾斜している傾斜部を有することを特徴とする請求項496に記載のシャッタ。
Priority Applications (46)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
RU2017106174A RU2670567C2 (ru) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Картридж для тонера, механизм подачи тонера и затвор |
EP22152641.1A EP4020090B1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
CN202011559203.6A CN112650036B (zh) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 调色剂盒、调色剂供给机构和闸板 |
MX2021000039A MX2021000039A (es) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Cartucho de toner, mecanismo de suministro de toner y obturador. |
EP19164338.6A EP3537223B1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
KR1020177002635A KR101871127B1 (ko) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 토너 카트리지 및 토너 공급 기구 |
CN202011559827.8A CN112650038B (zh) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 调色剂盒、调色剂供给机构和闸板 |
KR1020217019288A KR102422672B1 (ko) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 토너 카트리지 및 토너 공급 기구 |
KR1020187017298A KR102045167B1 (ko) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 토너 카트리지 및 토너 공급 기구 |
CN201580052038.6A CN107077086B (zh) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 调色剂盒、调色剂供给机构和闸板 |
AU2015297380A AU2015297380B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
KR1020197033171A KR102270414B1 (ko) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 토너 카트리지 및 토너 공급 기구 |
BR112017001779-2A BR112017001779B1 (pt) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Cartucho de toner e mecanismo de suprimento de toner |
EP15826664.3A EP3176642B1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
EP23200453.1A EP4290313A3 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
CN202011558942.3A CN112650035B (zh) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 调色剂盒、调色剂供给机构和闸板 |
SG11201700764XA SG11201700764XA (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
MX2021000124A MX2021000124A (es) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Cartucho de toner, mecanismo de suministro de toner y obturador. |
MYPI2017700329A MY189688A (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge and toner supplying mechanism |
ES15826664T ES2729161T3 (es) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Cartucho de tóner, mecanismo de suministro de tóner y obturador |
CA2956560A CA2956560A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
KR1020227024157A KR102661370B1 (ko) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 토너 카트리지 및 토너 공급 기구 |
GB1702934.9A GB2558320A (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
CN202011560083.1A CN112631096B (zh) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | 调色剂盒、调色剂供给机构和闸板 |
MX2017001413A MX2017001413A (es) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Cartucho de toner, mecanismo de suministro de toner y obturador. |
MX2020006404A MX2020006404A (es) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | Cartucho de toner, mecanismo de suministro de toner y obturador. |
ZA2017/00457A ZA201700457B (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2017-01-19 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
US15/417,931 US10761472B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2017-01-27 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
PH12017500183A PH12017500183B1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2017-01-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
CONC2017/0001950A CO2017001950A2 (es) | 2014-08-01 | 2017-02-27 | Cartucho de tóner, mecanismo de suministro de tóner y obturador |
AU2019200130A AU2019200130A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2019-01-09 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
AU2019200837A AU2019200837A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2019-02-07 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
US16/427,877 US11714374B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2019-05-31 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
PH12019502641A PH12019502641A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2019-11-22 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
US16/884,426 US11022934B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2020-05-27 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
PH12020500546A PH12020500546A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2020-06-08 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism , and shutter |
PH12020500545A PH12020500545A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2020-06-08 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
PH12020500547A PH12020500547A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2020-06-08 | Toner cartridge, toner supply mechanism, and shutter |
US17/036,406 US11709453B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2020-09-29 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
AU2021200529A AU2021200529B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2021-01-28 | Toner cartridge, toner suppling mechanism and shutter |
US17/203,924 US11609530B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2021-03-17 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
US17/231,105 US11650536B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2021-04-15 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
US17/506,803 US11703793B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2021-10-21 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
US18/124,675 US12078952B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2023-03-22 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
US18/370,478 US20240004342A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2023-09-20 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
US18/370,472 US20240004341A1 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2023-09-20 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
Applications Claiming Priority (6)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
JP2014-158119 | 2014-08-01 | ||
JP2014158119 | 2014-08-01 | ||
JP2014-158120 | 2014-08-01 | ||
JP2014158120 | 2014-08-01 | ||
JP2015032063 | 2015-02-20 | ||
JP2015-032063 | 2015-02-20 |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US15/417,931 Continuation US10761472B2 (en) | 2014-08-01 | 2017-01-27 | Toner cartridge, toner supplying mechanism and shutter |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
WO2016017828A1 true WO2016017828A1 (ja) | 2016-02-04 |
Family
ID=55217722
Family Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/JP2015/072438 WO2016017828A1 (ja) | 2014-08-01 | 2015-07-31 | トナーカートリッジ、トナー供給機構、シャッタ |
Country Status (22)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (10) | US10761472B2 (ja) |
EP (4) | EP3537223B1 (ja) |
JP (8) | JP6548503B2 (ja) |
KR (5) | KR102270414B1 (ja) |
CN (6) | CN112650038B (ja) |
AU (4) | AU2015297380B2 (ja) |
BR (1) | BR112017001779B1 (ja) |
CA (2) | CA3006118C (ja) |
CL (3) | CL2017000228A1 (ja) |
CO (1) | CO2017001950A2 (ja) |
ES (2) | ES2907765T3 (ja) |
GB (1) | GB2558320A (ja) |
MA (1) | MA54115A (ja) |
MX (6) | MX2017001413A (ja) |
MY (1) | MY189688A (ja) |
PH (5) | PH12017500183B1 (ja) |
PL (1) | PL4020090T3 (ja) |
RU (4) | RU2697013C2 (ja) |
SG (2) | SG11201700764XA (ja) |
TW (4) | TWI748591B (ja) |
WO (1) | WO2016017828A1 (ja) |
ZA (1) | ZA201700457B (ja) |
Cited By (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
CN107272375A (zh) * | 2016-03-31 | 2017-10-20 | 兄弟工业株式会社 | 调色剂盒 |
CN107272386A (zh) * | 2016-03-31 | 2017-10-20 | 兄弟工业株式会社 | 调色剂盒 |
JP2018031984A (ja) * | 2016-08-26 | 2018-03-01 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 現像装置 |
WO2022066203A1 (en) * | 2020-09-23 | 2022-03-31 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Developing device with sealing structure to seal shutter for developer inlet of developer supply portion |
Families Citing this family (22)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
CN112650038B (zh) * | 2014-08-01 | 2024-05-10 | 佳能株式会社 | 调色剂盒、调色剂供给机构和闸板 |
RU2741483C2 (ru) | 2016-09-30 | 2021-01-26 | Кэнон Кабусики Кайся | Картридж с тонером и механизм подачи тонера |
MY201943A (en) | 2016-09-30 | 2024-03-25 | Canon Kk | Toner cartridge and toner supplying mechanism |
CN108614398B (zh) * | 2016-12-12 | 2024-05-14 | 江西亿铂电子科技有限公司 | 一种带有可开闭的碳粉排出口的碳粉盒 |
JP6855284B2 (ja) * | 2017-03-03 | 2021-04-07 | キヤノン株式会社 | カートリッジ及び画像形成装置 |
JP2018151534A (ja) * | 2017-03-14 | 2018-09-27 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | 粉体容器、現像装置、および画像形成装置 |
CN110268361A (zh) * | 2017-04-24 | 2019-09-20 | 惠普发展公司有限责任合伙企业 | 低廓形平板计算机对接解决方案 |
US10310410B2 (en) * | 2017-07-21 | 2019-06-04 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Development cartridge, process cartridge, and image forming apparatus |
JP7051347B2 (ja) * | 2017-09-21 | 2022-04-11 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤補給容器及び現像剤補給システム |
KR20200025331A (ko) | 2018-08-30 | 2020-03-10 | 휴렛-팩커드 디벨롭먼트 컴퍼니, 엘.피. | 토너 리필 카트리지의 셔터 구조 |
JP7225769B2 (ja) * | 2018-12-18 | 2023-02-21 | 富士フイルムビジネスイノベーション株式会社 | 収納容器の取付構造、画像形成ユニット、画像形成装置 |
JP7255163B2 (ja) * | 2018-12-18 | 2023-04-11 | 富士フイルムビジネスイノベーション株式会社 | 収納容器の取付構造、画像形成ユニット、画像形成装置 |
JP7225768B2 (ja) * | 2018-12-18 | 2023-02-21 | 富士フイルムビジネスイノベーション株式会社 | 収納容器、収納容器の取付構造、画像形成ユニット、画像形成装置 |
KR20200107454A (ko) | 2019-03-08 | 2020-09-16 | 휴렛-팩커드 디벨롭먼트 컴퍼니, 엘.피. | 토너 카트리지의 파지부를 선택적으로 노출시키는 구조 |
MX2021011177A (es) | 2019-03-18 | 2022-01-19 | Canon Kk | Aparato y cartucho de formacion de imagen electrofotografica. |
JP7433777B2 (ja) * | 2019-04-26 | 2024-02-20 | キヤノン株式会社 | カートリッジ |
PL3982202T3 (pl) | 2019-09-17 | 2024-01-22 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Wkład z tonerem i urządzenie tworzące obraz |
JP7367476B2 (ja) * | 2019-11-13 | 2023-10-24 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 画像形成装置 |
JP7338453B2 (ja) * | 2019-12-24 | 2023-09-05 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 画像形成装置 |
JP2021117473A (ja) * | 2020-01-29 | 2021-08-10 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | プロセスカートリッジおよび画像形成装置 |
CN113281975A (zh) * | 2021-04-28 | 2021-08-20 | 宁波得力科贝技术有限公司 | 一种粉仓、硒鼓以及打印机 |
JP2024002834A (ja) | 2022-06-24 | 2024-01-11 | キヤノン株式会社 | トナーカートリッジ |
Citations (8)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
JP2006243763A (ja) * | 1997-09-30 | 2006-09-14 | Canon Inc | トナー供給容器及び電子写真画像形成装置 |
JP2011076062A (ja) * | 2009-09-04 | 2011-04-14 | Ricoh Co Ltd | トナー容器及び画像形成装置 |
JP2013015826A (ja) * | 2011-06-06 | 2013-01-24 | Canon Inc | 現像剤補給容器及び現像剤補給システム |
JP2013105113A (ja) * | 2011-11-16 | 2013-05-30 | Fuji Xerox Co Ltd | 現像剤の搬送装置および画像形成装置 |
JP2013205441A (ja) * | 2012-03-27 | 2013-10-07 | Fuji Xerox Co Ltd | 画像形成装置および収容容器 |
JP2013213910A (ja) * | 2012-04-02 | 2013-10-17 | Konica Minolta Inc | トナーボトル、補給ユニット、および画像形成装置 |
JP2013218276A (ja) * | 2012-03-15 | 2013-10-24 | Ricoh Co Ltd | 粉体収納容器、その粉体収納容器から現像剤を補給する粉体補給装置、およびそれが搭載される画像形成装置 |
JP2014182265A (ja) * | 2013-03-19 | 2014-09-29 | Canon Inc | 現像剤補給容器及び現像剤補給装置 |
Family Cites Families (67)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4245623A (en) | 1978-06-06 | 1981-01-20 | Erb Robert A | Method and apparatus for the hysteroscopic non-surgical sterilization of females |
JPH05500199A (ja) | 1989-12-21 | 1993-01-21 | ウイアトン・スチール・コーポレーシヨン | 容易アクセスシート金属容器構造 |
JPH08320634A (ja) * | 1994-08-17 | 1996-12-03 | Ricoh Co Ltd | 像担持体支持装置 |
JP3387596B2 (ja) | 1993-12-28 | 2003-03-17 | キヤノン株式会社 | トナーカートリッジ及び現像剤受け入れ装置 |
JP3044997B2 (ja) * | 1994-02-16 | 2000-05-22 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 画像形成装置における現像装置 |
JPH07306859A (ja) | 1994-05-12 | 1995-11-21 | Nec Corp | 機械翻訳装置 |
JPH07306589A (ja) | 1994-05-12 | 1995-11-21 | Brother Ind Ltd | 画像形成装置における現像装置 |
US5548384A (en) | 1995-04-06 | 1996-08-20 | International Communications Materials, Inc. | Toner supply cartridge |
EP0805379B1 (en) | 1996-04-29 | 1998-08-05 | Brother Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha | Toner cartridge having protrusions engageable with a development case shutter |
JP3869913B2 (ja) | 1996-09-30 | 2007-01-17 | キヤノン株式会社 | 電子写真画像形成装置に用いられる円筒部材及びプロセスカートリッジ |
JP3408166B2 (ja) | 1997-09-30 | 2003-05-19 | キヤノン株式会社 | トナー供給容器及び電子写真画像形成装置 |
JP2005326869A (ja) * | 1997-09-30 | 2005-11-24 | Canon Inc | トナー供給容器及び電子写真画像形成装置 |
JP3450757B2 (ja) * | 1998-09-22 | 2003-09-29 | キヤノン株式会社 | トナー補給容器 |
JP3554208B2 (ja) * | 1998-10-29 | 2004-08-18 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤供給装置 |
US6400916B1 (en) | 1998-11-30 | 2002-06-04 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Process cartridge and electrophotographic apparatus |
JP3450741B2 (ja) * | 1999-03-29 | 2003-09-29 | キヤノン株式会社 | トナー補給容器 |
JP4458642B2 (ja) | 1999-08-31 | 2010-04-28 | キヤノン株式会社 | 画像形成装置 |
US6785497B1 (en) | 2003-03-24 | 2004-08-31 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba | Toner cartridge and toner supply device |
JP4693393B2 (ja) * | 2003-11-19 | 2011-06-01 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤補給装置 |
JP4652783B2 (ja) * | 2003-12-10 | 2011-03-16 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤供給容器 |
JP2005211831A (ja) | 2004-01-30 | 2005-08-11 | Kurita Water Ind Ltd | スケール防止装置 |
JP4419589B2 (ja) * | 2004-02-06 | 2010-02-24 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | カートリッジ、現像装置及び画像形成装置 |
JP4579655B2 (ja) | 2004-11-12 | 2010-11-10 | キヤノン株式会社 | トナーカートリッジおよび画像形成装置 |
JP4636853B2 (ja) | 2004-11-12 | 2011-02-23 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤供給容器および画像形成装置 |
JP2006189675A (ja) | 2005-01-07 | 2006-07-20 | Canon Inc | 現像剤補給容器 |
JP4635645B2 (ja) * | 2005-02-28 | 2011-02-23 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 画像形成装置及びトナーカートリッジ |
US8190068B2 (en) | 2005-03-04 | 2012-05-29 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Developer supply container with mounting attitude regulation and drive receiving member rotation suppression features |
JP4328773B2 (ja) | 2005-03-04 | 2009-09-09 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤補給容器及び現像剤補給システム |
CN101794099B (zh) | 2005-03-04 | 2013-08-07 | 佳能株式会社 | 显影剂供给容器和显影剂供给系统 |
JP4701830B2 (ja) | 2005-05-11 | 2011-06-15 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | プロセスカートリッジ及び画像形成装置 |
CN2849776Y (zh) * | 2005-09-16 | 2006-12-20 | 珠海天威飞马打印耗材有限公司 | 碳粉盒 |
JP4386052B2 (ja) | 2006-07-04 | 2009-12-16 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | 現像剤カートリッジ、及び、画像形成装置 |
JP4714119B2 (ja) * | 2006-09-28 | 2011-06-29 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | 現像剤カートリッジ及び画像形成装置 |
JP2008134526A (ja) | 2006-11-29 | 2008-06-12 | Konica Minolta Business Technologies Inc | トナー補給機構、トナーカートリッジ及び画像形成装置 |
JP5056032B2 (ja) * | 2007-01-30 | 2012-10-24 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 現像装置およびトナーカートリッジ |
JP4411554B2 (ja) * | 2007-03-01 | 2010-02-10 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | トナーカートリッジ、現像装置および画像形成装置 |
JP5018413B2 (ja) | 2007-11-13 | 2012-09-05 | パナソニック株式会社 | トナーカートリッジ、記録装置、プロセスカートリッジ、及びシャッター開閉装置 |
JP5029659B2 (ja) * | 2009-06-30 | 2012-09-19 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 現像装置および現像剤カートリッジ |
BR112012008152B1 (pt) | 2009-09-04 | 2020-09-29 | Ricoh Company, Limited | Recipiente de toner e aparelho de formação de imagem |
JP2011186447A (ja) | 2010-02-15 | 2011-09-22 | Canon Inc | 現像装置及びプロセスカートリッジ |
JP5413251B2 (ja) | 2010-03-05 | 2014-02-12 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 画像形成装置 |
CL2010000577A1 (es) | 2010-06-03 | 2011-03-11 | Lexmark Int Inc | Cartucho de toner para usar con un dispositivo de formacion de imagenes, con una seccion principal que tiene una cavidad interior; una extension con una parte delantera; una estria ubicada en uno de los lados laterales de la extension; una salida; un obturador conectado operativamente con la salida; un engranaje impulsor. |
JP5177178B2 (ja) * | 2010-06-03 | 2013-04-03 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 画像形成装置 |
JP5549388B2 (ja) | 2010-06-07 | 2014-07-16 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | トナーカートリッジおよび画像形成装置 |
JP2012037555A (ja) | 2010-08-03 | 2012-02-23 | Brother Ind Ltd | トナー収容体 |
JP5777469B2 (ja) * | 2010-09-29 | 2015-09-09 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤補給容器及び現像剤補給システム |
JP5691391B2 (ja) | 2010-10-25 | 2015-04-01 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | 画像形成装置 |
JP5514697B2 (ja) * | 2010-11-02 | 2014-06-04 | 株式会社沖データ | 現像装置、画像形成ユニットおよび画像形成装置 |
JP5609559B2 (ja) * | 2010-11-09 | 2014-10-22 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | 現像剤搬送装置および画像形成装置 |
JP5614251B2 (ja) | 2010-11-10 | 2014-10-29 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | 現像剤の収容容器および画像形成装置 |
JP5716498B2 (ja) | 2011-03-31 | 2015-05-13 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | カートリッジ |
US8886093B2 (en) | 2011-04-05 | 2014-11-11 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba | Image forming apparatus, toner supply mechanism, and method of mounting and dismounting a toner cartridge |
US9176418B2 (en) * | 2011-09-29 | 2015-11-03 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Developer conveyance apparatus and process cartridge |
JP2013096173A (ja) | 2011-11-02 | 2013-05-20 | Kyanpekkusu Kogyo Kk | 水平搬送装置 |
US8867970B2 (en) | 2011-12-30 | 2014-10-21 | Lexmark International, Inc. | Toner cartridges having positional control features |
US8867966B2 (en) | 2011-12-30 | 2014-10-21 | Lexmark International, Inc. | Toner cartridge for use in an image forming device |
JP5901327B2 (ja) | 2012-02-09 | 2016-04-06 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像装置、プロセスカートリッジ、および画像形成装置 |
US8958725B2 (en) * | 2012-02-21 | 2015-02-17 | Fuji Xerox Co., Ltd. | Powder container having shield for shutter and image forming apparatus mounted with the same |
JP5675888B2 (ja) | 2012-05-17 | 2015-02-25 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤収納ユニット、現像装置、プロセスカートリッジ、画像形成装置 |
JP6202911B2 (ja) | 2012-09-07 | 2017-09-27 | キヤノン株式会社 | 画像形成装置、プロセスカートリッジ |
JP5980064B2 (ja) | 2012-09-13 | 2016-08-31 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像装置の製造方法及びプロセスカートリッジの製造方法 |
JP6053428B2 (ja) | 2012-09-27 | 2016-12-27 | キヤノン株式会社 | 現像剤収容容器、現像カートリッジ、プロセスカートリッジ及び画像形成装置 |
US9377714B2 (en) | 2012-12-14 | 2016-06-28 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Developer accommodating unit with frames for accommodating a developer accommodating member |
JP6376782B2 (ja) | 2014-03-10 | 2018-08-22 | キヤノン株式会社 | カートリッジ及び画像形成装置 |
JP6159690B2 (ja) | 2014-07-30 | 2017-07-05 | 京セラドキュメントソリューションズ株式会社 | 現像剤収容容器、およびこれを備えた画像形成装置 |
CN112650038B (zh) | 2014-08-01 | 2024-05-10 | 佳能株式会社 | 调色剂盒、调色剂供给机构和闸板 |
JP2017178972A (ja) | 2014-08-07 | 2017-10-05 | 日立化成株式会社 | Cmp用研磨液及びこれを用いた研磨方法 |
-
2015
- 2015-07-31 CN CN202011559827.8A patent/CN112650038B/zh active Active
- 2015-07-31 AU AU2015297380A patent/AU2015297380B2/en active Active
- 2015-07-31 TW TW109126504A patent/TWI748591B/zh active
- 2015-07-31 CN CN202011560083.1A patent/CN112631096B/zh active Active
- 2015-07-31 ES ES19164338T patent/ES2907765T3/es active Active
- 2015-07-31 MX MX2017001413A patent/MX2017001413A/es unknown
- 2015-07-31 CN CN201580052038.6A patent/CN107077086B/zh active Active
- 2015-07-31 KR KR1020197033171A patent/KR102270414B1/ko active IP Right Grant
- 2015-07-31 MX MX2020006404A patent/MX2020006404A/es unknown
- 2015-07-31 EP EP19164338.6A patent/EP3537223B1/en active Active
- 2015-07-31 CN CN202011559730.7A patent/CN112650037A/zh active Pending
- 2015-07-31 CA CA3006118A patent/CA3006118C/en active Active
- 2015-07-31 KR KR1020177002635A patent/KR101871127B1/ko active IP Right Grant
- 2015-07-31 TW TW108100624A patent/TWI703417B/zh active
- 2015-07-31 EP EP22152641.1A patent/EP4020090B1/en active Active
- 2015-07-31 CN CN202011559203.6A patent/CN112650036B/zh active Active
- 2015-07-31 MY MYPI2017700329A patent/MY189688A/en unknown
- 2015-07-31 SG SG11201700764XA patent/SG11201700764XA/en unknown
- 2015-07-31 EP EP15826664.3A patent/EP3176642B1/en active Active
- 2015-07-31 WO PCT/JP2015/072438 patent/WO2016017828A1/ja active Application Filing
- 2015-07-31 CA CA2956560A patent/CA2956560A1/en active Pending
- 2015-07-31 KR KR1020227024157A patent/KR102661370B1/ko active IP Right Grant
- 2015-07-31 TW TW106115850A patent/TWI655521B/zh active
- 2015-07-31 TW TW104124916A patent/TWI594089B/zh active
- 2015-07-31 CN CN202011558942.3A patent/CN112650035B/zh active Active
- 2015-07-31 PL PL22152641.1T patent/PL4020090T3/pl unknown
- 2015-07-31 KR KR1020187017298A patent/KR102045167B1/ko active IP Right Grant
- 2015-07-31 RU RU2018136223A patent/RU2697013C2/ru active
- 2015-07-31 SG SG10201900974YA patent/SG10201900974YA/en unknown
- 2015-07-31 GB GB1702934.9A patent/GB2558320A/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2015-07-31 BR BR112017001779-2A patent/BR112017001779B1/pt active IP Right Grant
- 2015-07-31 RU RU2017106174A patent/RU2670567C2/ru active
- 2015-07-31 MX MX2021000039A patent/MX2021000039A/es unknown
- 2015-07-31 MA MA054115A patent/MA54115A/fr unknown
- 2015-07-31 MX MX2021000124A patent/MX2021000124A/es unknown
- 2015-07-31 ES ES15826664T patent/ES2729161T3/es active Active
- 2015-07-31 EP EP23200453.1A patent/EP4290313A3/en active Pending
- 2015-07-31 JP JP2015152141A patent/JP6548503B2/ja active Active
- 2015-07-31 KR KR1020217019288A patent/KR102422672B1/ko active IP Right Grant
-
2017
- 2017-01-19 ZA ZA2017/00457A patent/ZA201700457B/en unknown
- 2017-01-27 CL CL2017000228A patent/CL2017000228A1/es unknown
- 2017-01-27 US US15/417,931 patent/US10761472B2/en active Active
- 2017-01-31 PH PH12017500183A patent/PH12017500183B1/en unknown
- 2017-01-31 MX MX2021000122A patent/MX2021000122A/es unknown
- 2017-01-31 MX MX2021000034A patent/MX2021000034A/es unknown
- 2017-02-27 CO CONC2017/0001950A patent/CO2017001950A2/es unknown
-
2019
- 2019-01-09 AU AU2019200130A patent/AU2019200130A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2019-02-07 AU AU2019200837A patent/AU2019200837A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2019-05-31 US US16/427,877 patent/US11714374B2/en active Active
- 2019-06-18 JP JP2019112980A patent/JP6746760B2/ja active Active
- 2019-07-09 CL CL2019001917A patent/CL2019001917A1/es unknown
- 2019-07-29 RU RU2019123845A patent/RU2720130C1/ru active
- 2019-11-22 PH PH12019502641A patent/PH12019502641A1/en unknown
-
2020
- 2020-04-17 RU RU2020113698A patent/RU2736921C1/ru active
- 2020-05-27 US US16/884,426 patent/US11022934B2/en active Active
- 2020-06-08 PH PH12020500546A patent/PH12020500546A1/en unknown
- 2020-06-08 PH PH12020500545A patent/PH12020500545A1/en unknown
- 2020-06-08 PH PH12020500547A patent/PH12020500547A1/en unknown
- 2020-07-08 JP JP2020118093A patent/JP6932822B2/ja active Active
- 2020-08-03 JP JP2020131847A patent/JP6980863B2/ja active Active
- 2020-09-29 US US17/036,406 patent/US11709453B2/en active Active
-
2021
- 2021-01-28 AU AU2021200529A patent/AU2021200529B2/en active Active
- 2021-03-10 CL CL2021000597A patent/CL2021000597A1/es unknown
- 2021-03-17 US US17/203,924 patent/US11609530B2/en active Active
- 2021-04-15 US US17/231,105 patent/US11650536B2/en active Active
- 2021-06-03 JP JP2021093945A patent/JP6953648B2/ja active Active
- 2021-10-21 US US17/506,803 patent/US11703793B2/en active Active
- 2021-11-09 JP JP2021182715A patent/JP7187651B2/ja active Active
-
2022
- 2022-11-22 JP JP2022186243A patent/JP7476285B2/ja active Active
-
2023
- 2023-03-22 US US18/124,675 patent/US12078952B2/en active Active
- 2023-09-20 US US18/370,472 patent/US20240004341A1/en active Pending
- 2023-09-20 US US18/370,478 patent/US20240004342A1/en active Pending
-
2024
- 2024-04-08 JP JP2024061962A patent/JP2024069726A/ja active Pending
Patent Citations (8)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
JP2006243763A (ja) * | 1997-09-30 | 2006-09-14 | Canon Inc | トナー供給容器及び電子写真画像形成装置 |
JP2011076062A (ja) * | 2009-09-04 | 2011-04-14 | Ricoh Co Ltd | トナー容器及び画像形成装置 |
JP2013015826A (ja) * | 2011-06-06 | 2013-01-24 | Canon Inc | 現像剤補給容器及び現像剤補給システム |
JP2013105113A (ja) * | 2011-11-16 | 2013-05-30 | Fuji Xerox Co Ltd | 現像剤の搬送装置および画像形成装置 |
JP2013218276A (ja) * | 2012-03-15 | 2013-10-24 | Ricoh Co Ltd | 粉体収納容器、その粉体収納容器から現像剤を補給する粉体補給装置、およびそれが搭載される画像形成装置 |
JP2013205441A (ja) * | 2012-03-27 | 2013-10-07 | Fuji Xerox Co Ltd | 画像形成装置および収容容器 |
JP2013213910A (ja) * | 2012-04-02 | 2013-10-17 | Konica Minolta Inc | トナーボトル、補給ユニット、および画像形成装置 |
JP2014182265A (ja) * | 2013-03-19 | 2014-09-29 | Canon Inc | 現像剤補給容器及び現像剤補給装置 |
Cited By (12)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
CN107272375A (zh) * | 2016-03-31 | 2017-10-20 | 兄弟工业株式会社 | 调色剂盒 |
CN107272386A (zh) * | 2016-03-31 | 2017-10-20 | 兄弟工业株式会社 | 调色剂盒 |
US10705456B2 (en) | 2016-03-31 | 2020-07-07 | Brother Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha | Toner cartridge attachable to image forming apparatus |
CN107272386B (zh) * | 2016-03-31 | 2020-10-27 | 兄弟工业株式会社 | 调色剂盒 |
CN107272375B (zh) * | 2016-03-31 | 2021-06-01 | 兄弟工业株式会社 | 调色剂盒 |
US11181852B2 (en) | 2016-03-31 | 2021-11-23 | Brother Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha | Toner cartridge attachable to image forming apparatus |
US11635707B2 (en) | 2016-03-31 | 2023-04-25 | Brother Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha | Toner cartridge attachable to image forming apparatus |
US12092974B2 (en) | 2016-03-31 | 2024-09-17 | Brother Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha | Toner cartridge attachable to image forming apparatus |
JP2018031984A (ja) * | 2016-08-26 | 2018-03-01 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | 現像装置 |
CN107783395A (zh) * | 2016-08-26 | 2018-03-09 | 兄弟工业株式会社 | 显影装置 |
WO2022066203A1 (en) * | 2020-09-23 | 2022-03-31 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Developing device with sealing structure to seal shutter for developer inlet of developer supply portion |
US11927898B2 (en) | 2020-09-23 | 2024-03-12 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Developing device with sealing structure to seal shutter for developer inlet of developer supply portion |
Also Published As
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
JP6980863B2 (ja) | トナーカートリッジおよびトナー供給機構 | |
WO2018062571A1 (ja) | トナー力ートリッジおよびトナー供給機構 | |
JP6682284B2 (ja) | トナーカートリッジおよびトナー供給機構 |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
121 | Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application |
Ref document number: 15826664 Country of ref document: EP Kind code of ref document: A1 |
|
ENP | Entry into the national phase |
Ref document number: 20177002635 Country of ref document: KR Kind code of ref document: A |
|
REEP | Request for entry into the european phase |
Ref document number: 2015826664 Country of ref document: EP |
|
ENP | Entry into the national phase |
Ref document number: 2956560 Country of ref document: CA |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 122018015122 Country of ref document: BR |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 12017500183 Country of ref document: PH Ref document number: MX/A/2017/001413 Country of ref document: MX |
|
NENP | Non-entry into the national phase |
Ref country code: DE |
|
REG | Reference to national code |
Ref country code: BR Ref legal event code: B01A Ref document number: 112017001779 Country of ref document: BR |
|
ENP | Entry into the national phase |
Ref document number: 2015297380 Country of ref document: AU Date of ref document: 20150731 Kind code of ref document: A Ref document number: 201702934 Country of ref document: GB Kind code of ref document: A Free format text: PCT FILING DATE = 20150731 |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: NC2017/0001950 Country of ref document: CO |
|
ENP | Entry into the national phase |
Ref document number: 2017106174 Country of ref document: RU Kind code of ref document: A |
|
ENP | Entry into the national phase |
Ref document number: 112017001779 Country of ref document: BR Kind code of ref document: A2 Effective date: 20170127 |